Minor improvements to make_formatted_string.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blobb73290ccd002c8f383acd684039999268096ae81
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
50 #include "systime.h"
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
88 #include <unistd.h>
90 #ifdef USE_GTK
91 #include "gtkutil.h"
92 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
93 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
94 #endif
95 #endif
97 #ifdef USE_LUCID
98 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
99 #endif
101 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
102 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
103 #define HACK_EDITRES
104 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
105 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
107 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
109 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
110 #if defined USE_MOTIF
111 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
112 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
113 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
115 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
116 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
119 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
120 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
122 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
123 #ifndef XtNpickTop
124 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
125 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
126 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
127 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
129 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
131 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
132 #include "widget.h"
133 #ifndef XtNinitialState
134 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
135 #endif
136 #endif
138 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
140 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
141 #ifdef USE_XIM
142 int use_xim = 1;
143 #else
144 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
145 #endif
149 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
150 start. */
152 static int any_help_event_p;
154 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
155 static Lisp_Object last_window;
157 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
158 use. */
160 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
162 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
163 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
164 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
165 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
167 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
169 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
170 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
171 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
172 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
174 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
176 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
178 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
180 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
182 static struct {
183 struct frame *f;
184 int eventtype;
185 } pending_event_wait;
187 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
188 /* The application context for Xt use. */
189 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
190 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
192 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
194 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
195 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
197 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
198 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
199 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
201 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
203 /* Mouse movement.
205 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
206 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
207 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
208 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
210 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
212 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
213 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
214 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
215 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
216 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
217 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
218 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
219 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
220 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
221 is off. */
223 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
225 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
226 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
227 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
229 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
231 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
232 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
233 an ordinary motion.
235 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
236 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
237 event. */
239 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
241 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
242 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
243 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
244 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
245 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
246 it's somewhat accurate. */
248 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
250 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
252 static Time last_user_time;
254 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
255 events. */
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
259 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
261 static int x_noop_count;
263 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
265 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
266 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
268 #ifdef USE_GTK
269 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
270 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
272 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
273 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
274 #endif
276 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
277 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
279 enum xembed_info
281 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
284 enum xembed_message
286 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
287 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
288 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
289 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
290 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
291 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
292 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
293 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
295 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
296 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
297 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
298 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
299 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
302 /* Used in x_flush. */
304 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
305 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
306 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
307 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
308 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
309 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
311 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
312 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
313 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
314 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
315 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
316 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
317 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
318 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
319 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
320 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
321 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
322 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
323 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
324 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
325 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
326 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
327 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
328 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
329 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
330 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
331 enum text_cursor_kinds);
333 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
334 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
335 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
336 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
337 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
338 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
339 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
340 enum scroll_bar_part *,
341 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
342 Time *);
343 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
344 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
345 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
346 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
347 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
348 int *, struct input_event *);
349 #ifdef USE_GTK
350 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
351 #endif
352 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
353 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
354 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
355 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
356 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
357 static void x_initialize (void);
360 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
362 static void
363 x_flush (struct frame *f)
365 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
366 connection may be broken. */
367 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
368 return;
370 BLOCK_INPUT;
371 if (f == NULL)
373 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
374 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
375 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
376 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
378 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
379 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
380 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
384 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
385 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
386 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
387 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
388 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
389 performance. */
391 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
394 /***********************************************************************
395 Debugging
396 ***********************************************************************/
398 #if 0
400 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
401 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
403 struct record
405 char *locus;
406 int type;
409 struct record event_record[100];
411 int event_record_index;
413 void
414 record_event (char *locus, int type)
416 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
417 event_record_index = 0;
419 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
420 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
421 event_record_index++;
424 #endif /* 0 */
428 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
430 struct x_display_info *
431 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
433 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
435 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
436 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
437 return dpyinfo;
439 return 0;
442 static Window
443 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
445 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
446 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
447 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
449 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
451 Window root;
452 Window *children;
453 unsigned int nchildren;
455 win = wi;
456 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
457 XFree (children);
460 return win;
463 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
465 void
466 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
468 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
469 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
470 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
471 double alpha = 1.0;
472 double alpha_min = 1.0;
473 unsigned long opac;
474 Window parent;
476 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
477 alpha = f->alpha[0];
478 else
479 alpha = f->alpha[1];
481 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
482 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
483 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
484 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
486 if (alpha < 0.0)
487 return;
488 else if (alpha > 1.0)
489 alpha = 1.0;
490 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
491 alpha = alpha_min;
493 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
495 x_catch_errors (dpy);
497 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
498 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
499 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
500 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
502 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
503 if (parent != None)
504 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
505 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
506 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
508 /* return unless necessary */
510 unsigned char *data;
511 Atom actual;
512 int rc, format;
513 unsigned long n, left;
515 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
516 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
517 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
518 &data);
520 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
522 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
523 XFree ((void *) data);
524 if (value == opac)
526 x_uncatch_errors ();
527 return;
532 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
533 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
534 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
535 x_uncatch_errors ();
539 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
541 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
545 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
547 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
551 /***********************************************************************
552 Starting and ending an update
553 ***********************************************************************/
555 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
556 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
557 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
558 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
559 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
561 static void
562 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
564 /* Nothing to do. */
568 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
569 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
570 position of W. */
572 static void
573 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
575 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
576 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
578 updated_window = w;
579 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
581 BLOCK_INPUT;
583 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
585 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
586 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
588 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
589 highlighting. */
590 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
591 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
594 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
598 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
600 static void
601 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
603 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
604 struct face *face;
606 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
607 if (face)
608 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
609 face->foreground);
611 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
612 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
615 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
617 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
618 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
620 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
621 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
622 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
624 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
625 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
626 here. */
628 static void
629 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
631 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
633 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
635 BLOCK_INPUT;
637 if (cursor_on_p)
638 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
639 output_cursor.vpos,
640 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
642 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
643 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
645 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
648 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
649 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
650 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
652 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
653 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
654 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
657 updated_window = NULL;
661 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
662 update_end. */
664 static void
665 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
667 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
668 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
670 #ifndef XFlush
671 BLOCK_INPUT;
672 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
673 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
674 #endif
678 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
679 complete update has been performed. The global variable
680 updated_window is not available here. */
682 static void
683 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
685 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
687 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
689 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
690 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
692 BLOCK_INPUT;
693 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
694 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
695 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
696 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
697 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
698 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
704 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
705 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
706 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
707 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
708 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
709 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
711 static void
712 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
714 struct window *w = updated_window;
715 struct frame *f;
716 int width, height;
718 eassert (w);
720 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
721 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
723 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
724 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
725 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
726 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
727 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
728 overhead is very small. */
729 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
730 && desired_row->full_width_p
731 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
732 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
733 width != 0)
734 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
735 height > 0))
737 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
739 BLOCK_INPUT;
740 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
741 0, y, width, height, False);
742 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
743 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
744 y, width, height, False);
745 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
749 static void
750 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
752 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
753 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
754 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
755 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
756 struct face *face = p->face;
758 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
759 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
761 if (!p->overlay_p)
763 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
765 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
766 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
767 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
768 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
769 if (face->stipple)
770 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
771 else
772 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
774 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
775 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
776 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
777 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
778 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
779 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
780 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
781 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
783 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
785 if (sb_width > 0)
787 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
788 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
789 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
791 if (bx < 0)
793 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
794 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
795 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
796 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
797 bx = bar_area_x;
798 if (bx >= 0)
800 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
802 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
803 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
804 row->y));
805 ny = row->visible_height;
808 else
810 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
812 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
813 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
815 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
816 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
820 #endif
821 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
822 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
824 if (!face->stipple)
825 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
828 if (p->which)
830 char *bits;
831 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
832 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
833 XGCValues gcv;
835 if (p->wd > 8)
836 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
837 else
838 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
840 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
841 by the server. */
842 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
843 (p->cursor_p
844 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
845 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
846 : face->foreground),
847 face->background, depth);
849 if (p->overlay_p)
851 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
852 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
853 bits, p->wd, p->h,
854 1, 0, 1);
855 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
856 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
857 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
858 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
861 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
862 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
863 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
865 if (p->overlay_p)
867 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
868 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
869 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
873 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
878 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
879 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
880 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
881 rarely happens). */
883 static void
884 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
888 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
889 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
891 static void
892 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
897 /***********************************************************************
898 Glyph display
899 ***********************************************************************/
903 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
904 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
905 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
906 int);
907 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
908 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
909 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
910 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
911 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
912 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
913 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
914 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
915 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
916 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
917 unsigned long *, double, int);
918 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
919 double, int, unsigned long);
920 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
921 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
922 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
923 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
924 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
925 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
926 int, int, int);
927 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
928 int, int, int, int, int, int,
929 XRectangle *);
930 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
931 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
932 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
934 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
935 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
936 #endif
939 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
940 face. */
942 static void
943 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
945 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
946 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
947 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
948 && !s->cmp)
949 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
950 else
952 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
953 XGCValues xgcv;
954 unsigned long mask;
956 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
957 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
959 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
960 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
961 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
962 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
963 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
964 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
965 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
967 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
968 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
969 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
971 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
972 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
975 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
976 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
977 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
979 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
980 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
981 mask, &xgcv);
982 else
983 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
984 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
986 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
991 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
993 static void
994 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
996 int face_id;
997 struct face *face;
999 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1000 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1001 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1002 if (face == NULL)
1003 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1005 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1006 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1007 else
1008 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1009 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1010 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1012 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1013 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1014 else
1016 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1017 except for FONT. */
1018 XGCValues xgcv;
1019 unsigned long mask;
1021 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1022 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1023 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1024 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1026 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1027 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1028 mask, &xgcv);
1029 else
1030 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1031 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1033 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1036 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1040 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1041 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1042 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1044 static inline void
1045 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1047 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1051 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1052 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1053 pattern. */
1055 static inline void
1056 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1058 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1060 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1062 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1063 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1065 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1067 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1068 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1070 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1072 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1073 s->stippled_p = 0;
1075 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1077 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1078 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1080 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1081 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1083 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1084 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1086 else
1088 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1089 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1092 /* GC must have been set. */
1093 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1097 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1098 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1100 static inline void
1101 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1103 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1104 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1106 if (n > 0)
1107 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1108 s->num_clips = n;
1112 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1113 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1114 the area of SRC. */
1116 static void
1117 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1119 XRectangle r;
1121 r.x = src->x;
1122 r.width = src->width;
1123 r.y = src->y;
1124 r.height = src->height;
1125 dst->clip[0] = r;
1126 dst->num_clips = 1;
1127 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1131 /* RIF:
1132 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1134 static void
1135 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1137 if (s->cmp == NULL
1138 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1139 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1141 struct font_metrics metrics;
1143 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1145 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1146 struct font *font = s->font;
1147 int i;
1149 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1150 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1151 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1153 else
1155 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1157 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1159 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1160 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1161 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1163 else if (s->cmp)
1165 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1166 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1171 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1173 static inline void
1174 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1176 XGCValues xgcv;
1177 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1178 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1179 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1180 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1184 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1185 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1186 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1187 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1188 contains the first component of a composition. */
1190 static void
1191 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1193 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1194 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1195 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1197 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1199 if (s->stippled_p)
1201 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1202 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1203 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1204 s->y + box_line_width,
1205 s->background_width,
1206 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1207 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1208 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1210 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1211 || s->font_not_found_p
1212 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1213 || force_p)
1215 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1216 s->background_width,
1217 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1218 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1224 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1226 static void
1227 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1229 int i, x;
1231 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1232 of S to the right of that box line. */
1233 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1234 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1235 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1236 else
1237 x = s->x;
1239 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1240 loaded. */
1241 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1243 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1245 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1246 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1247 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1248 s->height - 1);
1249 x += g->pixel_width;
1252 else
1254 struct font *font = s->font;
1255 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1256 int y;
1258 if (font->vertical_centering)
1259 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1261 y = s->ybase - boff;
1262 if (s->for_overlaps
1263 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1264 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1265 else
1266 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1267 if (s->face->overstrike)
1268 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1272 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1274 static void
1275 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1277 int i, j, x;
1278 struct font *font = s->font;
1280 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1281 of S to the right of that box line. */
1282 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1283 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1284 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1285 else
1286 x = s->x;
1288 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1289 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1290 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1291 this composition. */
1293 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1294 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1295 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1297 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1298 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1299 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1301 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1303 int y = s->ybase;
1305 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1306 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1307 space on the left or right. */
1308 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1310 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1311 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1313 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1314 if (s->face->overstrike)
1315 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1318 else
1320 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1321 Lisp_Object glyph;
1322 int y = s->ybase;
1323 int width = 0;
1325 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1327 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1328 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1329 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1330 else
1332 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1334 if (j < i)
1336 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1337 if (s->face->overstrike)
1338 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1339 x += width;
1341 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1342 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1343 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1344 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1345 if (s->face->overstrike)
1346 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1347 x += wadjust;
1348 j = i + 1;
1349 width = 0;
1352 if (j < i)
1354 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1355 if (s->face->overstrike)
1356 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1362 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1364 static void
1365 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1367 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1368 XChar2b char2b[8];
1369 int x, i, j;
1371 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1372 of S to the right of that box line. */
1373 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1374 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1375 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1376 else
1377 x = s->x;
1379 s->char2b = char2b;
1381 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1383 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1384 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1386 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1388 if (len > 0
1389 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1390 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1391 >= 1))
1393 Lisp_Object acronym
1394 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1395 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1396 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1397 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1398 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1399 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1402 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1404 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1405 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1406 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1407 str = buf;
1410 if (str)
1412 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1413 unsigned code;
1415 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1416 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1418 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1419 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1421 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1422 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1423 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1425 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1426 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1427 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1430 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1431 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1432 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1433 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1434 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1435 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1439 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1441 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1442 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1443 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1444 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1445 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1448 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1449 cannot be determined. */
1451 static struct frame *
1452 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1455 Lisp_Object tail;
1456 struct frame *f;
1458 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1460 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1461 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1462 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1463 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1464 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1465 widget = XtParent (widget);
1467 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1468 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1469 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1470 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1471 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1472 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1473 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1474 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1475 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1476 return f;
1478 abort ();
1482 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1484 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1485 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1486 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1487 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1488 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1489 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1492 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1493 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1495 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1496 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1499 #endif
1502 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1503 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1505 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1507 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1508 sizeof (Screen *)},
1509 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1510 sizeof (Colormap)}
1514 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1515 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1517 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1520 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1522 DPY is the display we are working on.
1524 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1525 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1526 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1527 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1529 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1530 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1532 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1533 we allocated the color or not.
1535 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1537 static Boolean
1538 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1539 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1540 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1542 Screen *screen;
1543 Colormap cmap;
1544 Pixel pixel;
1545 String color_name;
1546 XColor color;
1548 if (*nargs != 2)
1550 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1551 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1552 "XtToolkitError",
1553 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1554 return False;
1557 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1558 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1559 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1561 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1563 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1564 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1566 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1568 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1569 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1571 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1572 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1574 pixel = color.pixel;
1575 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1577 else
1579 String params[1];
1580 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1582 params[0] = color_name;
1583 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1584 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1585 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1586 params, &nparams);
1587 return False;
1590 if (to->addr != NULL)
1592 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1594 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1595 return False;
1598 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1600 else
1602 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1603 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1606 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1607 return True;
1611 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1612 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1613 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1615 APP is the application context in which we work.
1617 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1618 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1619 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1621 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1623 static void
1624 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1625 Cardinal *nargs)
1627 if (*nargs != 2)
1629 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1630 "XtToolkitError",
1631 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1632 NULL, NULL);
1634 else if (closure != NULL)
1636 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1637 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1638 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1639 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1640 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1645 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1648 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1649 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1650 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1651 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1653 static const XColor *
1654 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1656 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1658 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1660 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1661 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1662 int i;
1664 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1665 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1666 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1668 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1669 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1671 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1672 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1675 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1676 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1680 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1681 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1683 void
1684 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1686 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1688 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1690 int i;
1691 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1693 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1694 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1695 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1696 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1699 else
1700 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1704 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1705 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1707 void
1708 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1710 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1714 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1715 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1716 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1717 allocated. */
1719 static int
1720 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1722 int rc;
1724 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1725 if (rc == 0)
1727 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1728 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1729 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1730 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1731 int nearest, i;
1732 int max_color_delta = 255;
1733 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1734 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1735 int ncells;
1736 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1738 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1740 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1741 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1742 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1743 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1745 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1747 nearest = i;
1748 nearest_delta = delta;
1752 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1753 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1754 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1755 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1757 else
1759 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1760 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1761 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1762 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1763 XColor *cached_color;
1765 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1766 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1767 (cached_color->red != color->red
1768 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1769 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1771 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1772 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1773 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1777 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1778 if (rc)
1779 register_color (color->pixel);
1780 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1782 return rc;
1786 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1787 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1788 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1789 allocated. */
1792 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1794 gamma_correct (f, color);
1795 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1799 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1800 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1801 get color reference counts right. */
1803 unsigned long
1804 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1806 XColor color;
1808 color.pixel = pixel;
1809 BLOCK_INPUT;
1810 x_query_color (f, &color);
1811 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1812 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1813 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1814 register_color (pixel);
1815 #endif
1816 return color.pixel;
1820 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1821 boosted.
1823 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1824 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1825 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1826 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1827 use an additional additive factor.
1829 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1830 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1831 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1834 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1835 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1836 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1837 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1838 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1839 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1841 static int
1842 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1844 XColor color, new;
1845 long bright;
1846 int success_p;
1848 /* Get RGB color values. */
1849 color.pixel = *pixel;
1850 x_query_color (f, &color);
1852 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1853 eassert (factor >= 0);
1854 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1855 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1856 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1858 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1859 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1861 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1862 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1863 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1864 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1865 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1867 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1868 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1869 /* The additive adjustment. */
1870 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1872 if (factor < 1)
1874 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1875 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1876 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1878 else
1880 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1881 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1882 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1886 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1887 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1888 if (success_p)
1890 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1892 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1893 delta to the RGB values. */
1894 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1896 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1897 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1898 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1899 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1901 else
1902 success_p = 1;
1903 *pixel = new.pixel;
1906 return success_p;
1910 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1911 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1912 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1913 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1914 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1915 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1917 static void
1918 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1920 XGCValues xgcv;
1921 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1922 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1923 unsigned long pixel;
1924 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1925 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1926 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1927 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1929 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1930 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1932 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1933 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1934 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1935 if (relief->gc
1936 && relief->allocated_p)
1938 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1939 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1942 /* Allocate new color. */
1943 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1944 pixel = background;
1945 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1946 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1948 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1949 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1952 if (relief->gc == 0)
1954 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1955 mask |= GCStipple;
1956 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1958 else
1959 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1963 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1965 static void
1966 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1968 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1969 unsigned long color;
1971 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1972 color = s->face->box_color;
1973 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1974 && s->img->pixmap
1975 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1976 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1977 else
1979 XGCValues xgcv;
1981 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1982 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1983 color = xgcv.background;
1986 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1987 || color != di->relief_background)
1989 di->relief_background = color;
1990 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1991 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1992 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1993 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1998 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1999 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2000 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2001 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2002 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2003 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2004 when drawing. */
2006 static void
2007 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2008 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2009 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2010 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2012 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2013 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2014 int i;
2015 GC gc;
2017 if (raised_p)
2018 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2019 else
2020 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2021 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2023 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2024 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2025 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2026 corner pixels. */
2028 /* Top. */
2029 if (top_p)
2031 if (width == 1)
2032 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2033 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2034 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2036 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2037 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2038 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2039 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2042 /* Left. */
2043 if (left_p)
2045 if (width == 1)
2046 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2048 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2049 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2051 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2052 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2053 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2056 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2057 if (raised_p)
2058 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2059 else
2060 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2061 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2063 if (width > 1)
2065 /* Outermost top line. */
2066 if (top_p)
2067 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2068 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2069 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2071 /* Outermost left line. */
2072 if (left_p)
2073 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2076 /* Bottom. */
2077 if (bot_p)
2079 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2080 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2081 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2082 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2083 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2084 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2085 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2088 /* Right. */
2089 if (right_p)
2091 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2092 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2093 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2094 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2095 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2098 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2102 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2103 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2104 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2105 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2106 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2107 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2109 static void
2110 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2111 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2112 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2114 XGCValues xgcv;
2116 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2117 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2118 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2120 /* Top. */
2121 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2122 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2124 /* Left. */
2125 if (left_p)
2126 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2127 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2129 /* Bottom. */
2130 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2131 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2133 /* Right. */
2134 if (right_p)
2135 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2136 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2138 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2139 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2143 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2145 static void
2146 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2148 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2149 int left_p, right_p;
2150 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2151 XRectangle clip_rect;
2153 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2154 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2155 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2157 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2158 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2159 ? s->first_glyph
2160 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2162 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2163 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2164 left_x = s->x;
2165 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2166 ? last_x - 1
2167 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2168 top_y = s->y;
2169 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2171 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2172 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2173 && (s->prev == NULL
2174 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2175 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2176 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2177 && (s->next == NULL
2178 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2180 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2182 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2183 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2184 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2185 else
2187 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2188 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2189 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2194 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2196 static void
2197 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2199 int x = s->x;
2200 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2202 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2203 right of that line. */
2204 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2205 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2206 && s->slice.x == 0)
2207 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2209 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2210 by that margin. */
2211 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2212 x += s->img->hmargin;
2213 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2214 y += s->img->vmargin;
2216 if (s->img->pixmap)
2218 if (s->img->mask)
2220 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2221 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2222 trust on the shape extension to be available
2223 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2224 manually. */
2225 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2226 | GCFunction);
2227 XGCValues xgcv;
2228 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2230 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2231 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2232 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2233 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2234 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2236 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2237 image_rect.x = x;
2238 image_rect.y = y;
2239 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2240 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2241 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2242 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2243 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2244 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2246 else
2248 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2250 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2251 image_rect.x = x;
2252 image_rect.y = y;
2253 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2254 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2255 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2256 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2257 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2258 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2260 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2261 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2262 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2263 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2264 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2265 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2266 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2268 int relief = s->img->relief;
2269 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2270 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2271 x - relief, y - relief,
2272 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2273 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2277 else
2278 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2279 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2280 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2284 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2286 static void
2287 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2289 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2290 int extra_x, extra_y;
2291 XRectangle r;
2292 int x = s->x;
2293 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2295 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2296 right of that line. */
2297 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2298 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2299 && s->slice.x == 0)
2300 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2302 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2303 by that margin. */
2304 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2305 x += s->img->hmargin;
2306 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2307 y += s->img->vmargin;
2309 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2310 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2312 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2313 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2315 else
2317 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2318 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2321 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2322 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2324 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2325 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2326 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2328 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2329 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2331 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2332 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2335 x0 = x - thick - extra_x;
2336 y0 = y - thick - extra_y;
2337 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra_x;
2338 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra_y;
2340 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2341 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2342 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2343 s->slice.y == 0,
2344 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2345 s->slice.x == 0,
2346 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2347 &r);
2351 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2353 static void
2354 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2356 int x = 0;
2357 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2359 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2360 right of that line. */
2361 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2362 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2363 && s->slice.x == 0)
2364 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2366 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2367 by that margin. */
2368 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2369 x += s->img->hmargin;
2370 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2371 y += s->img->vmargin;
2373 if (s->img->pixmap)
2375 if (s->img->mask)
2377 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2378 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2379 trust on the shape extension to be available
2380 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2381 manually. */
2382 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2383 | GCFunction);
2384 XGCValues xgcv;
2386 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2387 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2388 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2389 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2390 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2392 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2393 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2394 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2395 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2397 else
2399 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2400 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2401 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2403 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2404 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2405 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2406 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2407 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2408 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2409 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2411 int r = s->img->relief;
2412 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2413 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2414 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2415 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2419 else
2420 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2421 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2422 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2426 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2427 give the rectangle to draw. */
2429 static void
2430 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2432 if (s->stippled_p)
2434 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2435 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2436 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2437 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2439 else
2440 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2444 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2446 s->y
2447 s->x +-------------------------
2448 | s->face->box
2450 | +-------------------------
2451 | | s->img->margin
2453 | | +-------------------
2454 | | | the image
2458 static void
2459 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2461 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2462 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2463 int height;
2464 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2466 height = s->height;
2467 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2468 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2469 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2470 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2472 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2473 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2474 flickering. */
2475 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2476 if (height > s->slice.height
2477 || s->img->hmargin
2478 || s->img->vmargin
2479 || s->img->mask
2480 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2481 || s->width != s->background_width)
2483 if (s->img->mask)
2485 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2486 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2487 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2488 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2489 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2491 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2492 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2493 s->background_width,
2494 s->height, depth);
2496 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2497 pixmap. */
2498 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2500 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2501 if (s->stippled_p)
2503 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2504 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2505 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2506 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2507 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2508 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2509 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2511 else
2513 XGCValues xgcv;
2514 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2515 &xgcv);
2516 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2517 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2518 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2519 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2522 else
2524 int x = s->x;
2525 int y = s->y;
2527 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2528 && s->slice.x == 0)
2529 x += box_line_hwidth;
2531 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2532 y += box_line_vwidth;
2534 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2537 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2540 /* Draw the foreground. */
2541 if (pixmap != None)
2543 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2544 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2545 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2546 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2547 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2549 else
2550 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2552 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2553 if (s->img->relief
2554 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2555 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2556 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2560 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2562 static void
2563 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2565 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2567 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2568 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2570 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2571 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2572 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2573 int x = s->x;
2575 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2577 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2579 if (x < left_x)
2581 background_width -= left_x - x;
2582 x = left_x;
2585 else
2587 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2588 stretch glyph. */
2589 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2591 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2592 background_width -= x - right_x;
2593 x += background_width;
2595 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2596 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2597 x -= width;
2599 /* Draw cursor. */
2600 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2602 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2603 if (width < background_width)
2605 int y = s->y;
2606 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2607 XRectangle r;
2608 GC gc;
2610 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2611 x += width;
2612 else
2613 x = s->x;
2614 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2615 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2617 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2618 gc = s->gc;
2620 else
2621 gc = s->face->gc;
2623 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2624 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2626 if (s->face->stipple)
2628 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2629 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2630 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2631 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2633 else
2635 XGCValues xgcv;
2636 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2637 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2638 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2639 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2643 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2645 int background_width = s->background_width;
2646 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2648 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2649 except for header line and mode line. */
2650 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2652 background_width -= left_x - x;
2653 x = left_x;
2655 if (background_width > 0)
2656 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2659 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2663 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2665 x0 wave_length = 2
2667 y0 * * * * *
2668 |* * * * * * * * *
2669 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2673 static void
2674 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2676 int wave_height = 2, wave_length = 3;
2677 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2678 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2680 dx = wave_length;
2681 dy = wave_height - 1;
2682 x0 = s->x;
2683 y0 = s->ybase + 1;
2684 width = s->width;
2685 xmax = x0 + width;
2687 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2689 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2690 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2692 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2693 return;
2695 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2697 /* Draw the waves */
2699 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2700 x2 = x1 + dx;
2701 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2702 y1 = y2 = y0;
2704 if (odd)
2705 y1 += dy;
2706 else
2707 y2 += dy;
2709 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2710 abort ();
2712 while (x1 <= xmax)
2714 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2715 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2716 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2717 odd = !odd;
2720 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2721 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2725 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2727 static void
2728 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2730 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2732 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2733 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2734 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2735 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2737 int width;
2738 struct glyph_string *next;
2740 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2741 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2742 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2743 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2745 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2746 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2747 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2748 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2749 else
2750 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2751 next->num_clips = 0;
2755 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2756 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2758 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2759 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2760 if (!s->for_overlaps
2761 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2762 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2763 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2766 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2767 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2768 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2769 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2770 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2772 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2773 && !s->clip_tail
2774 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2775 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2776 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2777 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2778 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2779 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2780 else
2781 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2783 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2785 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2786 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2787 break;
2789 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2790 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2791 break;
2793 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2794 if (s->for_overlaps)
2795 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2796 else
2797 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2798 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2799 break;
2801 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2802 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2803 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2804 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2805 else
2806 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2807 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2808 break;
2810 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2811 if (s->for_overlaps)
2812 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2813 else
2814 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2815 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2816 break;
2818 default:
2819 abort ();
2822 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2824 /* Draw underline. */
2825 if (s->face->underline_p)
2827 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2829 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2830 x_draw_underwave (s);
2831 else
2833 XGCValues xgcv;
2834 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2835 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2836 x_draw_underwave (s);
2837 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2840 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2842 unsigned long thickness, position;
2843 int y;
2845 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2847 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2848 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2849 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2851 else
2853 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2854 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2855 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2856 else
2857 thickness = 1;
2858 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2859 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2860 else
2862 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2863 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2864 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2865 specs, and its default is
2867 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2868 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2870 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2871 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2872 position = s->font->underline_position;
2873 else if (s->font)
2874 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2875 else
2876 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2878 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2880 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2881 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2882 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2883 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2884 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2885 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2886 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2887 s->underline_position = position;
2888 y = s->ybase + position;
2889 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2890 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2891 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2892 else
2894 XGCValues xgcv;
2895 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2896 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2897 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2898 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2899 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2903 /* Draw overline. */
2904 if (s->face->overline_p)
2906 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2908 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2909 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2910 s->width, h);
2911 else
2913 XGCValues xgcv;
2914 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2915 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2916 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2917 s->width, h);
2918 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2922 /* Draw strike-through. */
2923 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2925 unsigned long h = 1;
2926 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2928 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2929 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2930 s->width, h);
2931 else
2933 XGCValues xgcv;
2934 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2935 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2936 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2937 s->width, h);
2938 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2942 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2943 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2944 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2946 if (s->prev)
2948 struct glyph_string *prev;
2950 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2951 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2952 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2954 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2955 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2956 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2958 prev->hl = s->hl;
2959 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2960 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2961 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2962 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2963 else
2964 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2965 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2966 prev->hl = save;
2967 prev->num_clips = 0;
2971 if (s->next)
2973 struct glyph_string *next;
2975 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2976 if (next->hl != s->hl
2977 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2979 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2980 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2981 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2983 next->hl = s->hl;
2984 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2985 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2986 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2987 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2988 else
2989 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2990 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2991 next->hl = save;
2992 next->num_clips = 0;
2997 /* Reset clipping. */
2998 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2999 s->num_clips = 0;
3002 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
3004 static void
3005 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
3007 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3008 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3009 x, y, width, height,
3010 x + shift_by, y);
3013 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
3014 for X frames. */
3016 static void
3017 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
3019 abort ();
3023 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
3024 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
3026 void
3027 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
3029 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3030 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3034 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3036 static void
3037 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3039 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3040 longer visible. */
3041 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3042 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3043 output_cursor.x = -1;
3045 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3046 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3047 BLOCK_INPUT;
3049 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3051 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3052 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3053 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3055 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3056 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3057 redisplay, do it here. */
3058 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3059 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3060 #endif
3062 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3064 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3069 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3071 static void
3072 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3074 BLOCK_INPUT;
3077 #ifdef USE_GTK
3078 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3079 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3080 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3081 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3082 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3083 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3084 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3085 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3086 do { \
3087 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3088 cairo_fill (cr); \
3090 while (0)
3091 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3092 GdkGCValues vals;
3093 GdkGC *gc;
3094 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3095 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3096 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3097 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3098 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3099 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3100 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3101 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3102 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3103 GC gc;
3105 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3106 pixels into background pixels. */
3108 XGCValues values;
3110 values.function = GXxor;
3111 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3112 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3114 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3115 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3117 #endif
3119 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3120 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3121 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3122 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3123 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3124 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3125 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3127 int width;
3129 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3130 edge it is next to. */
3131 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3133 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3134 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3135 break;
3137 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3138 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3139 break;
3141 default:
3142 break;
3145 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3147 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3148 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3150 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3151 flash_left,
3152 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3153 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3154 width, flash_height);
3155 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3156 flash_left,
3157 (height - flash_height
3158 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3159 width, flash_height);
3162 else
3163 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3164 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3165 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3166 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3168 x_flush (f);
3171 EMACS_TIME wakeup, delay;
3173 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3174 EMACS_SET_SECS_NSECS (delay, 0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3175 EMACS_ADD_TIME (wakeup, wakeup, delay);
3177 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3178 available. */
3179 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3181 EMACS_TIME current, timeout;
3183 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3185 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3186 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3187 break;
3189 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3190 EMACS_SET_SECS_NSECS (timeout, 0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3192 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3193 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3197 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3198 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3200 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3201 flash_left,
3202 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3203 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3204 width, flash_height);
3205 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3206 flash_left,
3207 (height - flash_height
3208 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3209 width, flash_height);
3211 else
3212 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3213 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3214 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3215 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3217 #ifdef USE_GTK
3218 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3219 cairo_destroy (cr);
3220 #else
3221 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3222 #endif
3223 #undef XFillRectangle
3224 #else
3225 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3226 #endif
3227 x_flush (f);
3231 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3235 static void
3236 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3238 BLOCK_INPUT;
3239 if (invisible)
3241 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3242 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3243 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3245 else
3246 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3247 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3248 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3249 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3253 /* Make audible bell. */
3255 static void
3256 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3258 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3260 if (visible_bell)
3261 XTflash (f);
3262 else
3264 BLOCK_INPUT;
3265 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3266 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3267 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3273 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3274 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3275 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3276 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3278 static void
3279 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3281 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3286 /***********************************************************************
3287 Line Dance
3288 ***********************************************************************/
3290 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3291 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3293 static void
3294 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3296 abort ();
3300 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3302 static void
3303 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3305 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3306 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3308 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3309 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3310 fringe of W. */
3311 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3313 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3314 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3315 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3316 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3317 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3318 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3319 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3320 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3322 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3324 if (sb_width > 0)
3326 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3327 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3328 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3330 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3332 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3333 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3335 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3336 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3339 #endif
3341 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3342 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3343 bottom_y = y + height;
3345 if (to_y < from_y)
3347 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3348 line at the bottom. */
3349 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3350 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3351 else
3352 height = run->height;
3354 else
3356 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3357 at the bottom. */
3358 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3359 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3360 else
3361 height = run->height;
3364 BLOCK_INPUT;
3366 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3367 updated_window = w;
3368 x_clear_cursor (w);
3370 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3371 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3372 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3373 x, from_y,
3374 width, height,
3375 x, to_y);
3377 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3382 /***********************************************************************
3383 Exposure Events
3384 ***********************************************************************/
3387 static void
3388 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3390 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3391 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3392 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3393 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3394 BLOCK_INPUT;
3395 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3396 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3397 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3398 because of this (bug#9310). */
3399 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3400 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3401 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3402 x_uncatch_errors ();
3403 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3404 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3405 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3408 static void
3409 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3411 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3412 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3413 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3414 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3415 BLOCK_INPUT;
3416 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3417 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3418 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3419 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3420 x_uncatch_errors ();
3421 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3422 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3423 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3426 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3427 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3428 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3429 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3430 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3432 static void
3433 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3435 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3437 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3439 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3440 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3441 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3443 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3444 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3446 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3447 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3448 else
3449 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3452 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3455 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3456 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3457 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3459 static void
3460 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3462 if (type == FocusIn)
3464 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3466 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3467 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3469 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3470 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3471 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3472 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3473 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3475 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3476 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3480 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3482 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3483 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3484 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3485 #endif
3487 else if (type == FocusOut)
3489 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3491 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3493 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3494 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3497 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3498 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3499 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3500 #endif
3501 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3502 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3506 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3507 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3509 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3511 static void
3512 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3514 struct frame *frame;
3516 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3517 if (! frame)
3518 return;
3520 switch (event->type)
3522 case EnterNotify:
3523 case LeaveNotify:
3525 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3526 int focus_state
3527 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3529 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3530 && event->xcrossing.focus
3531 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3532 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3533 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3534 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3536 break;
3538 case FocusIn:
3539 case FocusOut:
3540 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3541 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3542 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3543 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3544 break;
3546 case ClientMessage:
3547 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3549 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3550 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3551 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3553 break;
3558 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3559 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3561 void
3562 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3564 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3566 #endif
3568 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3569 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3570 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3572 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3573 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3574 the appropriate X display info. */
3576 static void
3577 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3579 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3582 static void
3583 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3585 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3587 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3589 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3590 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3591 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3592 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3593 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3595 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3596 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3599 else
3600 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3602 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3604 if (old_highlight)
3605 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3606 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3607 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3613 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3615 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3616 static void
3617 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3619 int min_code, max_code;
3620 KeySym *syms;
3621 int syms_per_code;
3622 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3624 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3625 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3626 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3627 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3628 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3630 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3632 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3633 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3634 &syms_per_code);
3635 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3637 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3638 Alt keysyms are on. */
3640 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3641 int found_alt_or_meta;
3643 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3645 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3646 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3648 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3650 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3651 if (code == 0)
3652 continue;
3654 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3656 int code_col;
3658 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3660 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3662 switch (sym)
3664 case XK_Meta_L:
3665 case XK_Meta_R:
3666 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3667 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3668 break;
3670 case XK_Alt_L:
3671 case XK_Alt_R:
3672 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3673 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3674 break;
3676 case XK_Hyper_L:
3677 case XK_Hyper_R:
3678 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3679 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3680 code_col = syms_per_code;
3681 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3682 break;
3684 case XK_Super_L:
3685 case XK_Super_R:
3686 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3687 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3688 code_col = syms_per_code;
3689 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3690 break;
3692 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3693 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3694 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3695 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3696 code_col = syms_per_code;
3697 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3698 break;
3706 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3707 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3709 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3710 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3713 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3714 make them just meta, not alt. */
3715 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3717 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3720 XFree ((char *) syms);
3721 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3724 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3725 Emacs uses. */
3728 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3730 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3731 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3732 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3733 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3734 Lisp_Object tem;
3736 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3737 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3738 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3739 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3740 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3741 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3742 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3743 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3745 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3746 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3747 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3748 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3749 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3750 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3753 static int
3754 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3756 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3757 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3758 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3759 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3761 Lisp_Object tem;
3763 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3764 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3765 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3766 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3767 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3768 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3769 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3770 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3773 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3774 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3775 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3776 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3777 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3778 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3781 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3783 char *
3784 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3786 char *value;
3788 BLOCK_INPUT;
3789 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3790 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3792 return value;
3797 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3799 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3801 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3802 the mouse. */
3804 static Lisp_Object
3805 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3807 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3808 otherwise. */
3809 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3810 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3811 result->timestamp = event->time;
3812 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3813 event->state)
3814 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3815 ? up_modifier
3816 : down_modifier));
3818 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3819 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3820 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3821 result->arg = Qnil;
3822 return Qnil;
3826 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3827 The input handler calls this.
3829 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3830 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3831 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3832 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3834 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3835 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3837 static int
3838 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3840 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3841 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3842 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3844 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3845 return 0;
3847 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3849 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3850 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3851 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3852 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3853 return 1;
3857 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3858 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3859 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3860 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3861 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3862 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3864 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3865 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3866 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3867 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3868 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3869 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3870 return 1;
3873 return 0;
3877 /************************************************************************
3878 Mouse Face
3879 ************************************************************************/
3881 static void
3882 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3884 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3885 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3886 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3887 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3888 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3893 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3894 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3896 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3897 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3898 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3899 position on the scroll bar.
3901 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3902 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3903 the mouse is over.
3905 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3906 was at this position.
3908 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3910 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3911 movement. */
3913 static void
3914 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3915 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3916 Time *timestamp)
3918 FRAME_PTR f1;
3920 BLOCK_INPUT;
3922 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3923 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3924 else
3926 Window root;
3927 int root_x, root_y;
3929 Window dummy_window;
3930 int dummy;
3932 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3934 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3935 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3936 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3937 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3938 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3940 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3942 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3943 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3944 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3946 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3947 &root,
3949 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3950 a different screen. */
3951 &dummy_window,
3953 /* The position on that root window. */
3954 &root_x, &root_y,
3956 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3957 &dummy, &dummy,
3959 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3960 we don't care. */
3961 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3963 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3964 containing the pointer. */
3966 Window win, child;
3967 int win_x, win_y;
3968 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3970 win = root;
3972 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3973 structure is changing at the same time this function
3974 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3976 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3978 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3979 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3981 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3982 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3983 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3985 /* From-window, to-window. */
3986 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3988 /* From-position, to-position. */
3989 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3991 /* Child of win. */
3992 &child);
3993 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3995 else
3997 while (1)
3999 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4001 /* From-window, to-window. */
4002 root, win,
4004 /* From-position, to-position. */
4005 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4007 /* Child of win. */
4008 &child);
4010 if (child == None || child == win)
4011 break;
4012 #ifdef USE_GTK
4013 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4014 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
4015 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
4016 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
4017 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
4018 break;
4019 #endif
4020 win = child;
4021 parent_x = win_x;
4022 parent_y = win_y;
4025 /* Now we know that:
4026 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4027 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4028 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4029 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4030 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4031 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4032 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4033 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4034 never use them in that case.) */
4036 #ifdef USE_GTK
4037 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4038 want the edit window. */
4039 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4040 #else
4041 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4042 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4043 #endif
4045 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4046 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4047 on the frame. */
4048 if (f1 != NULL
4049 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4050 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4051 f1 = NULL;
4052 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4055 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4056 f1 = 0;
4058 x_uncatch_errors ();
4060 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4061 if (! f1)
4063 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4065 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4067 if (bar)
4069 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4070 win_x = parent_x;
4071 win_y = parent_y;
4075 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4076 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4078 if (f1)
4080 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4081 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4082 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4083 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4084 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4085 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4086 the frame are divided into. */
4088 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4089 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4091 *bar_window = Qnil;
4092 *part = 0;
4093 *fp = f1;
4094 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4095 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4096 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4101 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4106 /***********************************************************************
4107 Scroll bars
4108 ***********************************************************************/
4110 /* Scroll bar support. */
4112 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4113 manages it.
4114 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4115 bits. */
4117 static struct scroll_bar *
4118 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4120 Lisp_Object tail;
4122 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4123 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4124 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4126 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4128 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4130 frame = XCAR (tail);
4131 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4132 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4133 abort ();
4135 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4136 continue;
4138 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4139 right window ID. */
4140 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4141 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4142 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4143 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4144 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4145 condemned = Qnil,
4146 ! NILP (bar));
4147 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4148 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4149 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4150 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4153 return NULL;
4157 #if defined USE_LUCID
4159 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4160 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4162 static Widget
4163 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4165 Lisp_Object tail;
4167 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4169 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4171 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4172 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4174 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4175 return menu_bar;
4179 return NULL;
4182 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4185 /************************************************************************
4186 Toolkit scroll bars
4187 ************************************************************************/
4189 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4191 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4192 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4193 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4194 struct scroll_bar *);
4195 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4196 int, int, int);
4199 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4200 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4202 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4204 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4206 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4208 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4209 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4211 #ifndef USE_GTK
4212 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4214 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4216 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4218 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4219 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4220 to avoid jerkiness. */
4222 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4224 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4225 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4226 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4227 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4229 static void
4230 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4231 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4233 int scroll_bar_p;
4234 const char *end_action;
4236 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4237 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4238 end_action = "Release";
4239 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4240 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4241 end_action = "EndScroll";
4242 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4244 if (scroll_bar_p
4245 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4246 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4248 struct window *w;
4250 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4251 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4252 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4254 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4256 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4257 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4258 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4260 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4261 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4263 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4264 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4267 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4269 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4270 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4272 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4273 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4276 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4277 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4278 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4279 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4281 static void
4282 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4284 XEvent event;
4285 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4286 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4287 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4288 ptrdiff_t i;
4290 BLOCK_INPUT;
4292 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4293 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4294 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4295 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4296 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4297 ev->format = 32;
4299 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4300 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4301 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4302 into that array in the event. */
4303 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4304 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4305 break;
4307 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4309 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4310 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4311 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4312 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4313 scroll_bar_windows =
4314 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4315 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4316 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4317 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4320 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4321 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4322 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4323 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4324 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4325 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4327 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4328 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4329 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4330 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4331 #endif
4333 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4334 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4335 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4336 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4337 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4341 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4342 in *IEVENT. */
4344 static void
4345 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4347 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4348 Lisp_Object window;
4349 struct window *w;
4351 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4352 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4354 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4356 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4357 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4358 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4359 #ifdef USE_GTK
4360 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4361 #else
4362 ievent->timestamp =
4363 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4364 #endif
4365 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4366 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4367 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4368 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4369 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4373 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4375 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4377 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4380 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4381 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4382 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4384 static void
4385 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4387 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4388 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4389 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4391 switch (cs->reason)
4393 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4394 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4395 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4396 break;
4398 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4399 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4400 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4401 break;
4403 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4404 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4405 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4406 break;
4408 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4409 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4410 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4411 break;
4413 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4414 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4415 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4416 break;
4418 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4419 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4420 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4421 break;
4423 case XmCR_DRAG:
4425 int slider_size;
4427 /* Get the slider size. */
4428 BLOCK_INPUT;
4429 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4430 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4432 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4433 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4434 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4435 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4437 break;
4439 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4440 break;
4443 if (part >= 0)
4445 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4446 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4447 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4451 #elif defined USE_GTK
4453 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4454 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4456 static gboolean
4457 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4458 GtkScrollType scroll,
4459 gdouble value,
4460 gpointer user_data)
4462 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4463 gdouble position;
4464 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4465 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4466 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4468 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4469 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4472 switch (scroll)
4474 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4475 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4476 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4477 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4479 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4480 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4481 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4482 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4483 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4485 break;
4486 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4487 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4488 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4489 break;
4490 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4491 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4492 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4493 break;
4494 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4495 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4496 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4497 break;
4498 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4499 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4500 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4501 break;
4504 if (part >= 0)
4506 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4507 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4508 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4511 return FALSE;
4514 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4516 static gboolean
4517 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4518 GdkEventButton *event,
4519 gpointer user_data)
4521 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4522 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4523 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4525 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4526 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4527 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4530 return FALSE;
4534 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4536 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4537 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4538 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4539 the thumb is. */
4541 static void
4542 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4544 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4545 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4546 float shown;
4547 int whole, portion, height;
4548 int part;
4550 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4551 BLOCK_INPUT;
4552 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4553 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4555 whole = 10000000;
4556 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4558 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4559 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4560 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4561 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4562 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4563 bottom). */
4564 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4565 else
4566 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4568 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4569 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4570 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4571 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4575 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4576 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4577 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4578 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4579 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4580 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4581 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4583 static void
4584 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4586 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4587 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4588 int position = (long) call_data;
4589 Dimension height;
4590 int part;
4592 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4593 BLOCK_INPUT;
4594 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4595 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4597 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4598 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4600 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4601 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4602 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4603 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4604 else
4605 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4607 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4608 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4609 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4610 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4613 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4615 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4617 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4618 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4620 #ifdef USE_GTK
4621 static void
4622 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4624 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4626 BLOCK_INPUT;
4627 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4628 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4629 scroll_bar_name);
4630 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4633 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4635 static void
4636 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4638 Window xwindow;
4639 Widget widget;
4640 Arg av[20];
4641 int ac = 0;
4642 char const *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4643 unsigned long pixel;
4645 BLOCK_INPUT;
4647 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4648 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4649 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4650 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4651 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4652 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4653 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4654 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4655 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4657 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4658 if (pixel != -1)
4660 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4661 ++ac;
4664 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4665 if (pixel != -1)
4667 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4668 ++ac;
4671 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4672 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4674 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4675 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4676 (XtPointer) bar);
4677 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4678 (XtPointer) bar);
4679 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4680 (XtPointer) bar);
4681 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4682 (XtPointer) bar);
4683 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4684 (XtPointer) bar);
4685 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4686 (XtPointer) bar);
4687 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4688 (XtPointer) bar);
4690 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4691 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4693 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4694 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4695 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4696 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4698 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4700 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4701 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4702 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4703 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4704 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4705 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4706 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4707 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4709 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4710 if (pixel != -1)
4712 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4713 ++ac;
4716 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4717 if (pixel != -1)
4719 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4720 ++ac;
4723 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4725 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4726 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4728 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4729 if (pixel != -1)
4731 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4732 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4733 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4734 pixel = -1;
4735 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4738 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4740 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4741 if (pixel != -1)
4743 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4744 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4745 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4746 pixel = -1;
4747 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4751 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4752 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4753 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4754 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4755 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4756 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4757 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4758 colors itself. */
4760 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4761 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4762 ++ac;
4764 else
4765 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4766 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4767 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4769 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4770 the shadows. */
4771 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4772 ++ac;
4774 /* Specify the colors. */
4775 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4776 if (pixel != -1)
4778 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4779 ++ac;
4781 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4782 if (pixel != -1)
4784 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4785 ++ac;
4788 #endif
4790 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4791 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4794 char const *initial = "";
4795 char const *val = initial;
4796 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4797 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4798 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4799 #endif
4800 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4801 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4802 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4803 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4804 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4805 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4809 /* Define callbacks. */
4810 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4811 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4812 (XtPointer) bar);
4814 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4815 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4817 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4819 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4820 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4821 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4822 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4824 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4825 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4826 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4827 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4829 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4831 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4834 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4835 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4837 #ifdef USE_GTK
4838 static void
4839 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4841 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4844 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4845 static void
4846 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4847 int whole)
4849 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4850 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4851 float top, shown;
4853 BLOCK_INPUT;
4855 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4857 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4858 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4859 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4860 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4861 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4862 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4863 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4864 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4865 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4866 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4867 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4868 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4869 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4870 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4871 whole += portion;
4873 if (whole <= 0)
4874 top = 0, shown = 1;
4875 else
4877 top = (float) position / whole;
4878 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4881 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4883 int size, value;
4885 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4886 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4887 value. */
4888 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4889 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4890 size = max (size, 1);
4892 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4893 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4894 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4896 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4898 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4900 if (whole == 0)
4901 top = 0, shown = 1;
4902 else
4904 top = (float) position / whole;
4905 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4909 float old_top, old_shown;
4910 Dimension height;
4911 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4912 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4913 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4914 XtNheight, &height,
4915 NULL);
4917 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4918 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4919 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4920 else
4921 top = old_top;
4922 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4923 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4925 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4926 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4927 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4928 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4930 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4931 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4932 else
4934 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4935 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4936 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4938 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4942 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4944 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4946 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4948 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4952 /************************************************************************
4953 Scroll bars, general
4954 ************************************************************************/
4956 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4957 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4958 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4959 scroll bar. */
4961 static struct scroll_bar *
4962 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4964 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4965 struct scroll_bar *bar
4966 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4968 BLOCK_INPUT;
4970 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4971 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4972 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4974 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4975 unsigned long mask;
4976 Window window;
4978 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4979 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4980 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4982 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4983 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4984 | ExposureMask);
4985 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4987 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4989 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4990 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4991 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4992 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4993 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4994 left, top, width,
4995 window_box_height (w), False);
4997 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4998 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4999 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5000 top,
5001 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5002 height,
5003 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
5005 CopyFromParent,
5006 CopyFromParent,
5007 CopyFromParent,
5008 /* Attributes. */
5009 mask, &a);
5010 bar->x_window = window;
5012 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5014 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
5015 bar->top = top;
5016 bar->left = left;
5017 bar->width = width;
5018 bar->height = height;
5019 bar->start = 0;
5020 bar->end = 0;
5021 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5022 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
5024 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5025 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5026 bar->prev = Qnil;
5027 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5028 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5029 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5031 /* Map the window/widget. */
5032 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5034 #ifdef USE_GTK
5035 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5036 bar->x_window,
5037 top,
5038 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5039 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5040 max (height, 1));
5041 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5042 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5043 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5044 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5045 top,
5046 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5047 max (height, 1), 0);
5048 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5049 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5051 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5052 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5053 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5055 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5056 return bar;
5060 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5062 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5064 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5065 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5066 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5067 events.)
5069 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5070 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5071 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5072 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5073 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5075 static void
5076 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5078 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5079 Window w = bar->x_window;
5080 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5081 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5083 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5084 if (! rebuild
5085 && start == bar->start
5086 && end == bar->end)
5087 return;
5089 BLOCK_INPUT;
5092 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5093 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5094 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5096 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5097 the distance between start and end. */
5099 int length = end - start;
5101 if (start < 0)
5102 start = 0;
5103 else if (start > top_range)
5104 start = top_range;
5105 end = start + length;
5107 if (end < start)
5108 end = start;
5109 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5110 end = top_range;
5113 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5114 bar->start = start;
5115 bar->end = end;
5117 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5118 if (end > top_range)
5119 end = top_range;
5121 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5122 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5123 that many pixels tall. */
5124 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5126 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5127 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5128 if (0 < start)
5129 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5130 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5131 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5132 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5133 inside_width, start,
5134 False);
5136 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5137 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5138 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5139 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5141 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5142 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5143 /* x, y, width, height */
5144 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5145 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5146 inside_width, end - start);
5148 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5149 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5150 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5151 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5153 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5154 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5155 if (end < inside_height)
5156 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5157 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5158 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5159 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5160 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5161 False);
5165 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5168 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5170 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5171 nil. */
5173 static void
5174 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5176 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5177 BLOCK_INPUT;
5179 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5180 #ifdef USE_GTK
5181 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5182 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5183 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5184 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5185 #else
5186 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5187 #endif
5189 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5190 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5192 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5196 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5197 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5198 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5199 create one. */
5201 static void
5202 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5204 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5205 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5206 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5207 int window_y, window_height;
5208 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5209 int fringe_extended_p;
5210 #endif
5212 /* Get window dimensions. */
5213 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5214 top = window_y;
5215 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5216 height = window_height;
5218 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5219 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5221 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5222 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5223 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5224 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5225 else
5226 sb_width = width;
5228 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5229 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5230 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5231 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5232 else
5233 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5234 #else
5235 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5236 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5237 else
5238 sb_left = left;
5239 #endif
5241 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5242 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5243 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5244 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5245 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5246 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5247 else
5248 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5249 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5250 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5251 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5252 #endif
5254 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5255 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5257 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5259 BLOCK_INPUT;
5260 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5261 if (fringe_extended_p)
5262 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5263 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5264 else
5265 #endif
5266 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5267 left, top, width, height, False);
5268 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5271 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5273 else
5275 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5276 unsigned int mask = 0;
5278 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5280 BLOCK_INPUT;
5282 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5283 mask |= CWX;
5284 if (top != bar->top)
5285 mask |= CWY;
5286 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5287 mask |= CWWidth;
5288 if (height != bar->height)
5289 mask |= CWHeight;
5291 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5293 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5294 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5296 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5297 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5298 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5300 if (fringe_extended_p)
5301 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5302 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5303 else
5304 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5305 left, top, width, height, False);
5307 #ifdef USE_GTK
5308 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5309 bar->x_window,
5310 top,
5311 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5312 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5313 max (height, 1));
5314 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5315 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5316 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5317 top,
5318 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5319 max (height, 1), 0);
5320 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5322 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5324 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5325 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5326 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5328 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5329 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5330 height, False);
5331 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5332 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5333 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5334 height, False);
5337 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5338 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5339 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5340 example. */
5342 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5343 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5344 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5346 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5347 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5348 left + area_width - rest, top,
5349 rest, height, False);
5350 else
5351 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5352 left, top, rest, height, False);
5356 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5357 if (mask)
5359 XWindowChanges wc;
5361 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5362 wc.y = top;
5363 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5364 wc.height = height;
5365 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5366 mask, &wc);
5369 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5371 /* Remember new settings. */
5372 bar->left = sb_left;
5373 bar->top = top;
5374 bar->width = sb_width;
5375 bar->height = height;
5377 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5380 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5381 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5383 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5384 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5385 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5386 dragged. */
5387 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5389 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5391 if (whole == 0)
5392 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5393 else
5395 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5396 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5397 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5400 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5402 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5406 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5407 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5408 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5409 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5410 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5411 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5412 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5414 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5415 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5416 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5418 static void
5419 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5421 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5422 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5424 Lisp_Object bar;
5425 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5426 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5427 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5428 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5429 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5430 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5431 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5436 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5437 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5439 static void
5440 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5442 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5443 struct frame *f;
5445 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5446 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5447 abort ();
5449 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5451 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5452 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5453 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5455 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5456 the lists. */
5457 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5458 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5459 return;
5460 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5461 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5462 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5463 else
5464 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5465 one or the other! */
5466 abort ();
5468 else
5469 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5471 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5472 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5474 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5475 bar->prev = Qnil;
5476 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5477 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5478 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5481 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5482 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5484 static void
5485 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5487 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5489 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5491 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5492 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5493 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5495 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5497 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5499 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5501 next = b->next;
5502 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5505 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5506 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5510 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5511 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5512 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5514 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5515 mark bits. */
5517 static void
5518 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5520 Window w = bar->x_window;
5521 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5522 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5523 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5525 BLOCK_INPUT;
5527 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5529 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5530 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5531 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5532 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5534 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5535 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5537 /* x, y, width, height */
5538 0, 0,
5539 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5540 bar->height - 1);
5542 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5543 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5544 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5545 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5547 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5550 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5552 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5553 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5555 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5556 mark bits. */
5559 static void
5560 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5562 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5563 abort ();
5565 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5566 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5567 emacs_event->modifiers
5568 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5569 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5570 event->xbutton.state)
5571 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5572 ? up_modifier
5573 : down_modifier));
5574 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5575 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5576 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5578 int top_range
5579 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5580 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5582 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5583 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5585 if (y < bar->start)
5586 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5587 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5588 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5589 else
5590 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5592 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5593 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5594 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5595 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5597 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5598 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5600 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5601 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5603 #endif
5605 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5606 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5610 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5612 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5614 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5615 mark bits. */
5617 static void
5618 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5620 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5622 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5624 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5625 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5627 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5628 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5630 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5631 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5633 if (new_start != bar->start)
5635 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5637 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5642 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5644 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5645 on the scroll bar. */
5647 static void
5648 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5649 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5650 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5652 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5653 Window w = bar->x_window;
5654 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5655 int win_x, win_y;
5656 Window dummy_window;
5657 int dummy_coord;
5658 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5660 BLOCK_INPUT;
5662 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5663 report that. */
5664 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5666 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5667 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5668 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5670 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5671 &win_x, &win_y,
5673 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5674 &dummy_mask))
5676 else
5678 int top_range
5679 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5681 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5683 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5684 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5686 if (win_y < 0)
5687 win_y = 0;
5688 if (win_y > top_range)
5689 win_y = top_range;
5691 *fp = f;
5692 *bar_window = bar->window;
5694 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5695 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5696 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5697 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5698 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5699 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5700 else
5701 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5703 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5704 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5706 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5707 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5710 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5712 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5716 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5717 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5718 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5719 redraw them. */
5721 static void
5722 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5724 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5725 Lisp_Object bar;
5727 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5728 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5729 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5730 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5731 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5732 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5733 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5734 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5735 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5736 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5740 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5742 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5743 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5744 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5745 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5747 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5748 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5750 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5752 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5753 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5755 static int temp_index;
5756 static short temp_buffer[100];
5758 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5759 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5760 temp_index = 0; \
5761 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5763 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5764 on a particular display. */
5766 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5768 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5769 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5770 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5771 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5773 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5775 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5776 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5777 do \
5779 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5780 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5781 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5782 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5783 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5784 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5786 while (0)
5787 #endif
5789 enum
5791 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5792 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5793 X_EVENT_DROP
5796 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5797 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5798 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5800 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5801 this event further.
5802 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5804 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5805 static int
5806 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5808 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5809 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5810 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5811 was created. */
5813 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5814 event->xclient.window);
5816 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5818 #endif
5820 #ifdef USE_GTK
5821 static int current_count;
5822 static int current_finish;
5823 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5825 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5826 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5827 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5828 static GdkFilterReturn
5829 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5831 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5833 BLOCK_INPUT;
5834 if (current_count >= 0)
5836 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5838 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5840 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5841 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5842 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5843 so we do it here. */
5844 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5845 && dpyinfo
5846 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5848 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5849 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5851 #endif
5853 if (! dpyinfo)
5854 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5855 else
5856 current_count +=
5857 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5858 current_hold_quit);
5860 else
5861 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5863 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5865 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5866 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5868 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5870 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5873 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5874 enum xembed_message,
5875 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5877 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5879 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5880 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5881 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5883 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5885 static int
5886 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5887 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5889 union {
5890 struct input_event ie;
5891 struct selection_input_event sie;
5892 } inev;
5893 int count = 0;
5894 int do_help = 0;
5895 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5896 struct frame *f = NULL;
5897 struct coding_system coding;
5898 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5899 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5900 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5902 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5904 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5905 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5906 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5908 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5909 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5911 switch (event.type)
5913 case ClientMessage:
5915 if (event.xclient.message_type
5916 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5917 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5919 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5920 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5922 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5923 could be the shell widget window
5924 if the frame has no title bar. */
5925 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5926 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5927 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5928 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5929 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5930 #endif
5931 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5932 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5933 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5934 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5935 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5936 needed.
5938 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5939 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5940 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5941 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5942 Emacs. */
5944 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5945 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5946 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5947 if (f)
5949 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5950 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5951 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5952 x_catch_errors (d);
5953 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5954 /* The ICCCM says this is
5955 the only valid choice. */
5956 RevertToParent,
5957 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5958 /* This is needed to detect the error
5959 if there is an error. */
5960 XSync (d, False);
5961 x_uncatch_errors ();
5963 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5964 #endif /* 0 */
5965 goto done;
5968 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5969 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5971 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5972 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5973 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5974 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5975 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5976 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5977 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5978 session manager and one for this. */
5979 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5980 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5981 #endif
5983 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5984 event.xclient.window);
5985 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5986 for a single Emacs process. */
5987 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5988 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5989 event.xclient.window,
5990 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5991 else if (f)
5992 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5993 event.xclient.window,
5994 0, 0);
5996 goto done;
5999 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
6000 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
6002 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
6003 event.xclient.window);
6004 if (!f)
6005 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
6007 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
6008 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6009 goto done;
6012 goto done;
6015 if (event.xclient.message_type
6016 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
6018 goto done;
6021 if (event.xclient.message_type
6022 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
6024 int new_x, new_y;
6025 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6027 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
6028 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
6030 if (f)
6032 f->left_pos = new_x;
6033 f->top_pos = new_y;
6035 goto done;
6038 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6039 if (event.xclient.message_type
6040 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6042 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6043 if (f)
6044 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6045 &event, NULL);
6046 goto done;
6048 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6050 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6051 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6052 || (event.xclient.message_type
6053 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6055 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6056 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6057 currently never do because we are interested in
6058 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6059 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6060 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6061 if (!f)
6062 goto OTHER;
6063 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6064 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6065 goto done;
6068 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6069 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6070 we construct an input_event. */
6071 if (event.xclient.message_type
6072 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6074 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6075 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6076 goto done;
6078 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6080 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6081 if (event.xclient.message_type
6082 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6084 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6085 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6086 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6088 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6089 goto done;
6092 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6094 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6095 if (!f)
6096 goto OTHER;
6097 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6098 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6100 break;
6102 case SelectionNotify:
6103 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6104 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6105 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6106 goto OTHER;
6107 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6108 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6109 break;
6111 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6112 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6113 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6114 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6115 goto OTHER;
6116 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6118 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6120 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6121 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6122 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6123 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6124 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6126 break;
6128 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6129 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6130 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6131 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6132 goto OTHER;
6133 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6135 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6137 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6138 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6139 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6140 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6141 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6142 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6143 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6144 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6146 break;
6148 case PropertyNotify:
6149 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6150 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6151 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6152 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6153 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6155 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6156 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6157 treat it as deiconified. */
6158 if (! f->async_iconified)
6159 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6160 f->async_visible = 1;
6161 f->async_iconified = 0;
6162 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6163 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6164 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6165 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6168 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6169 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6170 goto OTHER;
6172 case ReparentNotify:
6173 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6174 if (f)
6176 int x, y;
6177 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6178 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6179 f->left_pos = x;
6180 f->top_pos = y;
6182 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6183 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6184 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6186 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6188 goto OTHER;
6190 case Expose:
6191 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6192 if (f)
6194 #ifdef USE_GTK
6195 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6196 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6197 event.xexpose.window,
6198 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6199 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6200 FALSE);
6201 #endif
6202 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6204 f->async_visible = 1;
6205 f->async_iconified = 0;
6206 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6207 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6209 else
6210 expose_frame (f,
6211 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6212 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6214 else
6216 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6217 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6218 #endif
6219 #if defined USE_LUCID
6220 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6221 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6222 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6224 Widget widget
6225 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6226 if (widget)
6227 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6229 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6231 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6232 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6233 goto OTHER;
6234 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6235 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6236 event.xexpose.window);
6238 if (bar)
6239 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6240 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6241 else
6242 goto OTHER;
6243 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6244 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6246 break;
6248 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6249 source area was obscured or not
6250 available. */
6251 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6252 if (f)
6254 expose_frame (f,
6255 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6256 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6257 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6259 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6260 else
6261 goto OTHER;
6262 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6263 break;
6265 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6266 source area was completely
6267 available. */
6268 break;
6270 case UnmapNotify:
6271 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6272 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6274 tip_window = 0;
6275 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6278 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6279 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6280 the frame was deleted. */
6282 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6283 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6284 display that won't ever be seen. */
6285 f->async_visible = 0;
6286 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6287 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6288 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6289 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6290 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6291 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6292 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6294 f->async_iconified = 1;
6296 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6297 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6300 goto OTHER;
6302 case MapNotify:
6303 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6304 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6305 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6306 goto OTHER;
6308 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6309 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6310 frame is visible. */
6311 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6312 if (f)
6314 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6315 the frame's display structures.
6316 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6317 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6318 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6319 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6320 if (! f->async_iconified)
6321 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6323 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6324 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6325 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6326 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6328 f->async_visible = 1;
6329 f->async_iconified = 0;
6330 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6332 if (f->iconified)
6334 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6335 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6337 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6338 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6339 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6340 to update the frame titles
6341 in case this is the second frame. */
6342 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6344 #ifdef USE_GTK
6345 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6346 #endif
6348 goto OTHER;
6350 case KeyPress:
6352 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6353 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6355 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6356 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6357 if (popup_activated ())
6358 goto OTHER;
6359 #endif
6361 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6363 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6364 mouse highlighting. */
6365 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6366 && (f == 0
6367 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6369 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6370 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6373 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6374 if (f == 0)
6376 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6377 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6378 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6379 event.xkey.window);
6380 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6382 widget = XtParent (widget);
6383 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6386 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6388 if (f != 0)
6390 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6391 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6392 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6393 his Emacs hang.
6395 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6396 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6397 status_return even if the input is too long to
6398 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6399 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6400 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6401 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6402 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6403 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6404 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6405 int modifiers;
6406 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6407 Lisp_Object c;
6409 #ifdef USE_GTK
6410 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6411 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6412 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6413 (see above). */
6414 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6415 #endif
6417 event.xkey.state
6418 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6419 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6420 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6422 /* This will have to go some day... */
6424 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6425 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6426 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6427 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6428 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6429 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6430 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6432 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6433 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6434 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6435 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6436 not it is combined with Meta. */
6437 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6438 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6440 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6441 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6443 Status status_return;
6445 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6446 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6447 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6448 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6449 &status_return);
6450 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6452 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6453 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6454 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6455 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6456 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6457 &status_return);
6459 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6460 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6461 break;
6462 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6464 keysym = NoSymbol;
6465 modifiers = 0;
6467 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6468 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6469 abort ();
6471 else
6472 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6473 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6474 &compose_status);
6475 #else
6476 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6477 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6478 &compose_status);
6479 #endif
6481 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6482 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6483 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6484 break;
6486 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6487 orig_keysym = keysym;
6489 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6490 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6491 inev.ie.modifiers
6492 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6493 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6495 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6496 translations to characters. */
6497 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6498 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6500 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6501 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6502 goto done_keysym;
6505 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6506 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6508 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6509 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6510 else
6511 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6512 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6513 goto done_keysym;
6516 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6517 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6518 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6519 Vx_keysym_table,
6520 Qnil),
6521 NATNUMP (c)))
6523 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6524 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6525 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6526 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6527 goto done_keysym;
6530 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6531 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6532 || keysym == XK_Delete
6533 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6534 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6535 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6536 #endif
6537 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6538 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6539 #ifdef HPUX
6540 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6541 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6542 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6543 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6544 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6545 #endif
6546 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6547 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6548 #endif
6549 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6550 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6551 #endif
6552 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6553 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6554 #endif
6555 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6556 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6557 #endif
6558 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6559 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6560 #endif
6561 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6562 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6563 #endif
6564 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6565 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6566 #endif
6567 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6568 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6569 #endif
6570 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6571 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6572 #endif
6573 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6574 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6575 #endif
6576 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6577 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6578 #endif
6579 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6580 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6581 #endif
6582 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6583 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6584 #endif
6585 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6586 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6587 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6588 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6589 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6590 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6591 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6592 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6593 don't have real modifiers but
6594 should be treated similarly to
6595 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6596 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6597 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6598 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6599 #endif
6602 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6603 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6604 key. */
6605 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6606 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6607 goto done_keysym;
6610 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6611 ptrdiff_t i;
6612 int nchars, len;
6614 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6616 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6617 nchars++;
6618 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6621 if (nchars < nbytes)
6623 /* Decode the input data. */
6625 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6626 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6627 we used just above and the locale. */
6628 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6629 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6630 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6631 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6632 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6633 gives us composition information. */
6634 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6636 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6637 nbytes);
6638 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6639 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6640 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6641 nbytes = coding.produced;
6642 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6643 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6646 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6647 character events. */
6648 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6650 int ch;
6651 if (nchars == nbytes)
6652 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6653 else
6654 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6655 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6656 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6657 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6658 inev.ie.code = ch;
6659 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6662 count += nchars;
6664 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6666 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6667 break;
6670 done_keysym:
6671 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6672 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6673 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6674 client. */
6675 break;
6676 #else
6677 goto OTHER;
6678 #endif
6680 case KeyRelease:
6681 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6682 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6683 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6684 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6685 client. */
6686 break;
6687 #else
6688 goto OTHER;
6689 #endif
6691 case EnterNotify:
6692 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6693 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6695 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6697 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6698 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6700 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6701 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6702 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6703 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6704 #ifdef USE_GTK
6705 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6706 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6707 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6708 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6709 #endif
6710 goto OTHER;
6712 case FocusIn:
6713 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6714 goto OTHER;
6716 case LeaveNotify:
6717 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6718 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6720 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6721 if (f)
6723 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6725 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6726 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6727 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6728 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6731 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6732 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6733 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6734 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6735 if (any_help_event_p)
6736 do_help = -1;
6738 #ifdef USE_GTK
6739 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6740 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6741 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6742 #endif
6743 goto OTHER;
6745 case FocusOut:
6746 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6747 goto OTHER;
6749 case MotionNotify:
6751 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6752 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6753 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6755 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6756 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6757 f = last_mouse_frame;
6758 else
6759 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6761 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6763 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6764 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6767 #ifdef USE_GTK
6768 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6769 f = 0;
6770 #endif
6771 if (f)
6774 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6775 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6776 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6778 Lisp_Object window;
6780 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6781 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6782 0, 0);
6784 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6785 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6786 will be selected only when it is active. */
6787 if (WINDOWP (window)
6788 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6789 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6790 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6791 create event iff we don't leave the
6792 selected frame. */
6793 && (focus_follows_mouse
6794 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6795 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6797 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6798 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6801 last_window=window;
6803 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6804 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6806 else
6808 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6809 struct scroll_bar *bar
6810 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6811 event.xmotion.window);
6813 if (bar)
6814 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6815 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6817 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6818 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6819 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6822 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6823 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6824 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6825 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6826 do_help = 1;
6827 goto OTHER;
6830 case ConfigureNotify:
6831 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6832 #ifdef USE_GTK
6833 if (!f
6834 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6835 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6837 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6838 event.xconfigure.height);
6839 f = 0;
6841 #endif
6842 if (f)
6844 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6845 #ifndef USE_GTK
6846 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6847 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6849 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6850 is called by the code that handles resizing
6851 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6853 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6854 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6855 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6856 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6857 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6858 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6859 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6861 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6862 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6863 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6866 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6867 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6868 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6869 #endif
6871 #ifdef USE_GTK
6872 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6873 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6874 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6875 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6876 #endif
6878 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6881 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6882 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6883 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6884 #endif
6887 goto OTHER;
6889 case ButtonRelease:
6890 case ButtonPress:
6892 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6893 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6894 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6896 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6897 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6898 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6900 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6901 && last_mouse_frame
6902 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6903 f = last_mouse_frame;
6904 else
6905 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6907 #ifdef USE_GTK
6908 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6909 f = 0;
6910 #endif
6911 if (f)
6913 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6914 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6915 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6917 Lisp_Object window;
6918 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6919 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6921 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6922 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6924 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6926 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6927 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6928 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6929 event.xbutton.state));
6933 if (!tool_bar_p)
6934 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6935 if (! popup_activated ())
6936 #endif
6938 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6940 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6941 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6943 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6944 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6946 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6947 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6949 else
6950 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6952 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6953 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6954 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6956 else
6958 struct scroll_bar *bar
6959 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6960 event.xbutton.window);
6962 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6963 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6964 scroll bars. */
6965 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6967 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6968 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6970 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6971 if (bar)
6972 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6973 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6976 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6978 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6979 last_mouse_frame = f;
6981 if (!tool_bar_p)
6982 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6984 else
6985 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6987 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6988 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6989 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6990 if (f != 0)
6991 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6993 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6994 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6995 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6996 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6997 Instead, save it away
6998 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6999 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
7000 if (! popup_activated ()
7001 #ifdef USE_GTK
7002 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
7003 && event.xbutton.button < 3
7004 #endif
7005 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
7006 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
7007 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
7008 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
7009 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7010 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
7011 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
7012 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
7014 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
7015 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
7016 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7018 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
7020 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
7021 goto OTHER;
7023 else
7024 goto OTHER;
7025 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7027 break;
7029 case CirculateNotify:
7030 goto OTHER;
7032 case CirculateRequest:
7033 goto OTHER;
7035 case VisibilityNotify:
7036 goto OTHER;
7038 case MappingNotify:
7039 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7040 local cache. */
7041 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7043 case MappingModifier:
7044 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7045 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7046 case MappingKeyboard:
7047 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7049 goto OTHER;
7051 case DestroyNotify:
7052 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7053 break;
7055 default:
7056 OTHER:
7057 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7058 BLOCK_INPUT;
7059 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7060 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7061 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7062 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7063 break;
7066 done:
7067 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7069 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7070 count++;
7073 if (do_help
7074 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7076 Lisp_Object frame;
7078 if (f)
7079 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7080 else
7081 frame = Qnil;
7083 if (do_help > 0)
7085 any_help_event_p = 1;
7086 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7087 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7089 else
7091 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7092 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7094 count++;
7097 SAFE_FREE ();
7098 *eventptr = event;
7099 return count;
7102 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7104 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7105 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7106 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7108 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7110 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7112 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7113 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7115 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7117 if (dpyinfo)
7118 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7120 return finish;
7122 #endif
7125 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7126 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler only if SYNC_INPUT is
7127 not defined.
7128 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7130 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7131 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7132 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7133 C chars).
7135 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7137 static int
7138 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7140 int count = 0;
7141 int event_found = 0;
7143 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7145 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7146 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7147 pending_signals = 1;
7148 #endif
7149 return -1;
7152 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7153 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7154 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7155 #endif
7156 BLOCK_INPUT;
7158 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7159 input_signal_count++;
7161 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7162 ++handling_signal;
7163 #endif
7165 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7166 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7168 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7169 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7172 #ifndef USE_GTK
7173 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7175 int finish;
7176 XEvent event;
7178 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7180 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7181 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7182 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7183 continue;
7184 #endif
7185 event_found = 1;
7187 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7188 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7190 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7191 goto out;
7194 out:;
7196 #else /* USE_GTK */
7198 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7199 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7200 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7201 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7203 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7204 from all displays. */
7206 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7208 current_count = count;
7209 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7211 gtk_main_iteration ();
7213 count = current_count;
7214 current_count = -1;
7215 current_hold_quit = 0;
7217 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7218 break;
7220 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7222 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7223 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7224 if (! event_found)
7226 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7227 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7228 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7229 x_noop_count++;
7230 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7232 x_noop_count=0;
7234 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7235 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7237 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7239 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7240 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7244 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7245 raise it now. */
7246 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7247 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7249 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7250 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7253 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7254 --handling_signal;
7255 #endif
7256 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7258 return count;
7264 /***********************************************************************
7265 Text Cursor
7266 ***********************************************************************/
7268 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7269 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7271 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7272 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7273 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7275 static void
7276 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7278 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7279 XRectangle clip_rect;
7280 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7282 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7284 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7285 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7286 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7287 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7288 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7290 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7294 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7296 static void
7297 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7299 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7300 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7301 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7302 int x, y, wd, h;
7303 XGCValues xgcv;
7304 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7305 GC gc;
7307 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7308 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7309 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7310 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7311 return;
7313 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7314 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7315 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7317 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7318 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7319 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7320 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7321 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7322 else
7323 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7324 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7325 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7327 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7328 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7329 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7330 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7334 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7336 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7337 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7338 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7339 --gerd. */
7341 static void
7342 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7344 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7345 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7347 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7348 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7349 and mini-buffer. */
7350 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7351 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7352 return;
7354 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7355 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7356 the bar might not be in the window. */
7357 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7359 struct glyph_row *r;
7360 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7361 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7363 else
7365 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7366 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7367 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7368 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7369 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7370 XGCValues xgcv;
7372 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7373 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7374 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7375 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7376 that the glyph is legible. */
7377 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7378 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7379 else
7380 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7381 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7383 if (gc)
7384 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7385 else
7387 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7388 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7391 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7393 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7395 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7397 if (width < 0)
7398 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7399 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7401 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7403 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7404 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7405 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7406 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7408 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7409 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7410 width, row->height);
7412 else
7414 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7416 if (width < 0)
7417 width = row->height;
7419 width = min (row->height, width);
7421 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7422 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7424 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7425 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7426 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7427 row->height - width),
7428 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7431 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7436 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7438 static void
7439 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7441 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7442 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7443 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7444 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7448 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7450 static void
7451 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7453 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7454 x, y, width, height, False);
7455 #ifdef USE_GTK
7456 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7457 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7458 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7459 #endif
7463 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7465 static void
7466 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7468 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7470 if (on_p)
7472 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7473 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7475 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7476 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7477 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7478 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7480 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7481 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7483 else
7485 switch (cursor_type)
7487 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7488 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7489 break;
7491 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7492 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7493 break;
7495 case BAR_CURSOR:
7496 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7497 break;
7499 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7500 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7501 break;
7503 case NO_CURSOR:
7504 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7505 break;
7507 default:
7508 abort ();
7512 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7513 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7514 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7515 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7516 #endif
7519 #ifndef XFlush
7520 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7521 #endif
7525 /* Icons. */
7527 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7530 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7532 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7534 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7535 return 1;
7537 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7538 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7539 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7540 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7542 if (STRINGP (file))
7544 #ifdef USE_GTK
7545 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7546 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7547 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7548 return 0;
7549 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7550 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7551 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7553 else
7555 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7556 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7558 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7560 #ifdef USE_GTK
7562 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7563 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7564 return 0;
7566 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7568 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7569 if (rc != -1)
7570 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7572 #endif
7574 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7575 if (rc == -1)
7577 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7578 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7579 if (rc == -1)
7580 return 1;
7582 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7583 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7587 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7588 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7589 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7590 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7591 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7593 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7596 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7597 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7599 return 0;
7603 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7604 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7607 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7609 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7610 return 1;
7613 XTextProperty text;
7614 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7615 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7616 text.format = 8;
7617 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7618 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7621 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7622 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7623 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7624 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7626 return 0;
7629 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7631 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7632 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7634 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7635 be called from a signal handler.
7638 struct x_error_message_stack {
7639 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7640 Display *dpy;
7641 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7643 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7645 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7646 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7647 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7649 static void
7650 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7652 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7653 x_error_message->string,
7654 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7657 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7658 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7659 operating on.
7661 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7662 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7663 stored in *x_error_message.
7665 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7666 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7668 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7670 void
7671 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7673 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7675 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7676 XSync (dpy, False);
7678 data->dpy = dpy;
7679 data->string[0] = 0;
7680 data->prev = x_error_message;
7681 x_error_message = data;
7684 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7685 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7687 void
7688 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7690 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7692 BLOCK_INPUT;
7694 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7695 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7696 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7697 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7699 tmp = x_error_message;
7700 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7701 xfree (tmp);
7702 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7705 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7706 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7707 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7709 void
7710 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7712 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7713 XSync (dpy, False);
7715 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7717 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7718 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7719 x_uncatch_errors ();
7720 error (format, string);
7724 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7725 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7728 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7730 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7731 XSync (dpy, False);
7733 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7736 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7738 void
7739 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7741 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7744 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7745 * idea. --lorentey */
7746 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7748 void
7749 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7751 while (x_error_message)
7752 x_uncatch_errors ();
7754 #endif
7756 #if 0
7757 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7758 x_trace_wire (void)
7760 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7762 #endif /* ! 0 */
7765 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7766 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7767 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7768 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7769 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7771 static void
7772 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7773 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7775 #ifdef USG
7776 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7777 must reestablish each time */
7778 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7779 #endif /* USG */
7783 /************************************************************************
7784 Handling X errors
7785 ************************************************************************/
7787 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7789 static char *error_msg;
7791 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7792 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7794 static void
7795 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7797 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7798 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7799 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7801 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7802 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7803 handling_signal = 0;
7805 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7806 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7808 if (dpyinfo)
7810 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7811 frame on it. */
7812 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7813 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7816 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7817 that are on the dead display. */
7818 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7820 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7821 minibuf_frame
7822 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7823 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7824 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7825 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7826 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7827 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7830 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7831 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7832 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7833 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7834 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7835 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7837 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7838 trying to find a replacement. */
7839 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7840 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7843 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7844 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7845 if (dpyinfo)
7847 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7848 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7849 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7850 #ifdef USE_GTK
7851 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7852 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7853 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7854 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7855 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7856 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7857 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7858 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7859 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7860 error_msg);
7861 abort ();
7862 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7864 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7865 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7867 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7868 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7869 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7870 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7871 abort ();
7874 Lisp_Object tmp;
7875 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7876 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7880 if (terminal_list == 0)
7882 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7883 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7884 /* NOTREACHED */
7887 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7888 #ifdef SIGIO
7889 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7890 #endif
7891 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7892 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7894 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7895 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7897 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7898 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7900 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7901 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7902 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7903 error ("%s", error_msg);
7906 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7907 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7908 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7910 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7911 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7913 static int
7914 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7916 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7917 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7918 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7919 && event->minor_code == 0)
7921 return 0;
7923 #endif
7925 if (x_error_message)
7926 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7927 else
7928 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7929 return 0;
7932 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7933 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7934 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7936 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7938 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7939 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7941 static void NO_INLINE
7942 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7944 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7946 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7947 or colors that are not defined. */
7949 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7950 return;
7952 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7953 original error handler. */
7955 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7956 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7957 buf, event->request_code);
7958 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7962 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7963 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7964 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7966 static int
7967 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7969 char buf[256];
7971 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7972 DisplayString (display));
7973 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7974 return 0;
7977 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7979 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7980 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7981 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7982 FONT-OBJECT. */
7984 Lisp_Object
7985 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7987 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7989 if (fontset < 0)
7990 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7991 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7992 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7993 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7994 do. */
7995 return font_object;
7997 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7998 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7999 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
8000 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
8001 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
8003 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
8005 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
8006 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8008 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8009 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8010 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
8012 else
8014 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8015 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
8018 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8020 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8021 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8022 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8023 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8024 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8027 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8028 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8029 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8031 BLOCK_INPUT;
8032 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8033 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8035 #endif
8037 return font_object;
8041 /***********************************************************************
8042 X Input Methods
8043 ***********************************************************************/
8045 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8047 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8049 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8050 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8051 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8053 static void
8054 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8056 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8057 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8059 BLOCK_INPUT;
8061 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8062 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8064 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8065 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8067 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8068 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8072 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8073 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8074 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8075 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8078 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8080 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8081 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8082 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8083 #endif
8085 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8086 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8088 static void
8089 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8091 XIM xim;
8093 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8094 if (use_xim)
8096 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8097 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8098 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8099 emacs_class);
8100 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8102 if (xim)
8104 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8105 XIMCallback destroy;
8106 #endif
8108 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8109 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8111 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8112 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8113 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8114 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8115 #endif
8119 else
8120 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8121 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8125 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8127 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8128 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8129 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8130 when the callback was registered. */
8132 static void
8133 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8135 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8136 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8138 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8139 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8140 return;
8142 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8144 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8145 as they have no XIC. */
8146 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8148 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8150 BLOCK_INPUT;
8151 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8153 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8155 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8156 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8157 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8159 create_frame_xic (f);
8160 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8161 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8162 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8164 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8165 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8170 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8174 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8177 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8178 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8179 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8180 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8182 static void
8183 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8185 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8186 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8187 if (use_xim)
8189 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8190 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8191 ptrdiff_t len;
8193 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8194 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8195 len = strlen (resource_name);
8196 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8197 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8198 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8199 resource_name, emacs_class,
8200 xim_instantiate_callback,
8201 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8202 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8203 least, hence the configure test. */
8204 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8205 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8206 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8207 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8209 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8213 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8215 static void
8216 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8218 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8219 if (use_xim)
8221 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8222 if (dpyinfo->display)
8223 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8224 NULL, emacs_class,
8225 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8226 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8227 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8228 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8229 if (dpyinfo->display)
8230 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8231 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8232 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8234 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8237 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8241 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8242 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8244 static void
8245 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8247 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8249 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8250 is already for the top-left corner. */
8251 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8252 return;
8254 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8255 position that fits on the screen. */
8256 if (flags & XNegative)
8257 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8258 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8261 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8263 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8264 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8265 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8267 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8268 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8269 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8270 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8271 is right, though.
8273 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8274 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8276 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8277 #endif
8279 if (flags & YNegative)
8280 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8281 - height + f->top_pos;
8284 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8285 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8286 so the flags should correspond. */
8287 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8290 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8291 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8292 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8293 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8294 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8296 void
8297 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8299 int modified_top, modified_left;
8301 if (change_gravity > 0)
8303 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8304 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8306 f->top_pos = yoff;
8307 f->left_pos = xoff;
8308 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8309 if (xoff < 0)
8310 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8311 if (yoff < 0)
8312 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8313 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8315 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8317 BLOCK_INPUT;
8318 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8320 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8321 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8323 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8325 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8326 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8327 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8328 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8329 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8332 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8333 modified_left, modified_top);
8335 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8336 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8337 ? 1 : 0);
8339 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8340 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8341 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8342 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8343 of the frame.
8345 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8346 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8347 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8349 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8350 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8351 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8352 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8353 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8354 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8356 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8359 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8360 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8361 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8362 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8363 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8365 static int
8366 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8368 Atom actual_type;
8369 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8370 int i, rc, actual_format;
8371 Window wmcheck_window;
8372 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8373 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8374 long max_len = 65536;
8375 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8376 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8377 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8379 BLOCK_INPUT;
8381 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8382 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8383 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8384 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8385 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8386 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8388 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8390 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8391 x_uncatch_errors ();
8392 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8393 return 0;
8396 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8397 XFree (tmp_data);
8399 /* Check if window exists. */
8400 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8401 x_sync (f);
8402 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8404 x_uncatch_errors ();
8405 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8406 return 0;
8409 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8411 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8412 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8413 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8414 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8415 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8416 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8418 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8419 tmp_data = NULL;
8420 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8421 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8422 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8423 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8424 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8426 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8428 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8429 x_uncatch_errors ();
8430 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8431 return 0;
8434 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8435 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8436 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8439 rc = 0;
8441 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8442 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8444 x_uncatch_errors ();
8445 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8447 return rc;
8450 static void
8451 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8453 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8455 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8456 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8457 make_number (32),
8458 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8459 Fcons
8460 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8461 Fcons
8462 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8463 value != 0
8464 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8465 : Qnil)));
8468 void
8469 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8471 Lisp_Object frame;
8472 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8474 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8476 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8477 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8480 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8481 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8482 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8484 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8486 static int
8487 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8488 Window window,
8489 int *size_state,
8490 int *sticky)
8492 Atom actual_type;
8493 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8494 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8495 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8496 long max_len = 65536;
8497 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8498 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8499 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8501 *sticky = 0;
8502 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8504 BLOCK_INPUT;
8505 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8506 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8507 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8508 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8509 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8511 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8513 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8514 x_uncatch_errors ();
8515 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8516 return ! f->iconified;
8519 x_uncatch_errors ();
8521 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8523 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8524 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8526 is_hidden = 1;
8527 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8529 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8531 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8532 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8533 else
8534 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8536 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8538 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8539 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8540 else
8541 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8543 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8544 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8545 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8546 *sticky = 1;
8549 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8550 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8551 return ! is_hidden;
8554 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8556 static int
8557 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8559 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8560 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8561 int cur, dummy;
8563 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8565 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8566 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8567 if (!have_net_atom)
8568 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8570 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8572 Lisp_Object frame;
8574 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8576 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8577 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8578 are sent at once. */
8579 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8581 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8582 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8583 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8584 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8585 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8586 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8587 break;
8588 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8589 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8590 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8591 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8592 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8593 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8594 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8595 break;
8596 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8597 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8598 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8599 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8600 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8601 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8602 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8603 break;
8604 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8605 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8606 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8607 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8608 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8609 break;
8610 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8611 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8612 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8613 else
8614 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8615 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8618 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8622 return have_net_atom;
8625 static void
8626 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8628 if (f->async_visible)
8630 BLOCK_INPUT;
8631 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8632 x_sync (f);
8633 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8638 static int
8639 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8641 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8642 Lisp_Object lval;
8643 int sticky = 0;
8644 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8646 lval = Qnil;
8647 switch (value)
8649 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8650 lval = Qfullwidth;
8651 break;
8652 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8653 lval = Qfullheight;
8654 break;
8655 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8656 lval = Qfullboth;
8657 break;
8658 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8659 lval = Qmaximized;
8660 break;
8663 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8664 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8666 return not_hidden;
8669 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8670 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8671 static void
8672 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8674 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8675 return;
8677 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8678 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8680 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8681 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8682 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8684 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8686 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8687 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8689 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8691 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8692 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8693 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8694 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8695 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8696 break;
8697 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8698 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8699 break;
8700 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8701 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8704 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8705 width, height);
8709 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8710 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8711 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8712 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8713 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8714 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8715 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8717 static void
8718 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8720 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8722 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8723 window manager window around the frame. */
8725 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8727 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8729 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8731 int adjusted_left;
8732 int adjusted_top;
8734 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8735 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8736 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8738 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8740 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8741 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8743 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8744 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8746 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8748 else
8749 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8750 frame's position. */
8752 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8756 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8757 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8758 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8759 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8760 of an exact comparison. */
8762 static void
8763 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8765 int count = 0;
8767 while (count++ < 50)
8769 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8771 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8772 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8773 loop. */
8775 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8776 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8778 if (fuzzy)
8780 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8781 pixels. */
8783 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8784 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8785 return;
8787 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8788 return;
8791 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8792 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8794 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8798 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8799 void
8800 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8802 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8804 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8805 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8806 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8808 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8809 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8811 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8812 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8813 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8814 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8815 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8817 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8819 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8820 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8821 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8822 BLOCK_INPUT;
8823 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8825 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8826 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8828 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8829 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8830 break;
8832 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8833 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8834 break; /* Timeout */
8836 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8837 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8841 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8842 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8843 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8844 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8846 static void
8847 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8849 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8851 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8852 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8853 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8855 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8857 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8859 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8860 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8861 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8862 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8864 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8865 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8866 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8867 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8870 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8871 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8872 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8873 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8874 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8876 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8877 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8878 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8879 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8881 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8882 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8883 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8884 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8885 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8887 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8888 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8890 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8891 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8892 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8893 if (f->async_visible)
8894 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8895 else
8897 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8898 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8899 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8900 x_sync (f);
8905 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8906 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8907 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8908 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8910 void
8911 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8913 BLOCK_INPUT;
8915 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8917 int r, c;
8919 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8920 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8921 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8922 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8923 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8924 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8925 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8926 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8927 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8928 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8929 is however. */
8930 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8931 #endif
8932 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8933 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8934 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8935 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8936 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8937 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8938 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8941 #ifdef USE_GTK
8942 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8943 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8944 else
8945 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8946 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8948 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8950 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8952 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8953 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8955 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8956 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8957 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8958 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8959 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8961 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8964 /* Mouse warping. */
8966 void
8967 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8969 int pix_x, pix_y;
8971 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8972 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8974 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8975 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8977 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8978 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8980 BLOCK_INPUT;
8982 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8983 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8984 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8987 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8989 void
8990 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8992 BLOCK_INPUT;
8994 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8995 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8996 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8999 /* Raise frame F. */
9001 void
9002 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
9004 BLOCK_INPUT;
9005 if (f->async_visible)
9006 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9008 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9009 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9012 /* Lower frame F. */
9014 static void
9015 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
9017 if (f->async_visible)
9019 BLOCK_INPUT;
9020 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9021 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9022 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9026 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
9028 void
9029 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
9031 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
9032 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
9033 if (f->async_visible)
9034 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
9035 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
9038 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9040 void
9041 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
9043 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9044 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9046 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9047 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
9049 Lisp_Object frame;
9050 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9051 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9052 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
9053 make_number (32),
9054 Fcons (make_number (1),
9055 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9056 Qnil)));
9060 static void
9061 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
9063 if (raise_flag)
9064 x_raise_frame (f);
9065 else
9066 x_lower_frame (f);
9069 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9071 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9073 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9075 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9077 static void
9078 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9080 unsigned long data[2];
9081 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9083 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9084 data[1] = flags;
9086 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9087 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9088 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9090 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9092 static void
9093 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9094 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9096 XEvent event;
9098 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9099 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9100 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9101 event.xclient.format = 32;
9102 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9103 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9104 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9105 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9106 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9108 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9109 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9110 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9113 /* Change of visibility. */
9115 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9116 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9117 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9118 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9119 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9120 finishes with it. */
9122 void
9123 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9125 Lisp_Object type;
9126 int original_top, original_left;
9127 int retry_count = 2;
9129 retry:
9131 BLOCK_INPUT;
9133 type = x_icon_type (f);
9134 if (!NILP (type))
9135 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9137 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9139 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9140 call x_set_offset a second time
9141 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9142 before the window gets really visible. */
9143 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9144 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9145 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9146 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9148 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9150 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9151 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9152 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9153 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9154 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9155 else
9157 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9158 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9160 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9161 #ifdef USE_GTK
9162 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9163 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9164 #else
9165 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9166 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9167 else
9168 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9169 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9170 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9173 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9175 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9176 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9177 so that incoming events are handled. */
9179 Lisp_Object frame;
9180 int count;
9181 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9182 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9183 will set it when they are handled. */
9184 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9186 original_left = f->left_pos;
9187 original_top = f->top_pos;
9189 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9190 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9192 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9194 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9195 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9196 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9197 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9199 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9200 because the window manager may choose the position
9201 and we don't want to override it. */
9203 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9204 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9205 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9206 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9207 && previously_visible)
9209 Drawable rootw;
9210 int x, y;
9211 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9213 BLOCK_INPUT;
9215 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9216 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9217 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9218 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9219 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9220 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9221 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9222 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9223 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9225 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9226 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9227 original_left, original_top);
9229 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9232 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9234 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9235 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9236 MapNotify at all.. */
9237 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9238 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9240 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9241 x_sync (f);
9243 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9244 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9245 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9246 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9247 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9248 probably a bug. */
9249 if (input_polling_used ())
9251 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9252 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9253 handler reset it. */
9254 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9255 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9256 poll_for_input_1 ();
9257 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9260 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9261 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9264 /* 2000-09-28: In
9266 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9267 (iconify-frame f)
9268 (raise-frame f))
9270 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9271 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9272 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9273 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9275 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9276 goto retry;
9280 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9282 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9284 void
9285 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9287 Window window;
9289 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9290 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9292 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9293 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9294 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9296 BLOCK_INPUT;
9298 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9299 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9300 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9301 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9302 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9303 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9305 #ifdef USE_GTK
9306 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9307 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9308 else
9309 #else
9310 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9311 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9312 else
9313 #endif
9316 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9317 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9319 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9320 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9324 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9325 just by the event that we get from the server.
9326 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9327 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9328 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9329 f->visible = 0;
9330 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9331 f->async_visible = 0;
9332 f->async_iconified = 0;
9334 x_sync (f);
9336 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9339 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9341 void
9342 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9344 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9345 int result;
9346 #endif
9347 Lisp_Object type;
9349 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9350 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9351 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9353 if (f->async_iconified)
9354 return;
9356 BLOCK_INPUT;
9358 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9360 type = x_icon_type (f);
9361 if (!NILP (type))
9362 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9364 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9365 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9367 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9368 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9370 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9371 f->iconified = 1;
9372 f->visible = 1;
9373 f->async_iconified = 1;
9374 f->async_visible = 0;
9375 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9376 return;
9378 #endif
9380 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9382 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9384 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9385 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9386 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9387 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9388 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9389 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9390 so we have to record it here. */
9391 f->iconified = 1;
9392 f->visible = 1;
9393 f->async_iconified = 1;
9394 f->async_visible = 0;
9395 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9396 return;
9399 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9400 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9401 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9402 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9404 if (!result)
9405 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9407 f->async_iconified = 1;
9408 f->async_visible = 0;
9411 BLOCK_INPUT;
9412 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9413 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9414 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9416 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9417 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9418 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9419 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9420 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9421 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9423 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9424 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9426 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9427 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9429 XEvent msg;
9431 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9432 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9433 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9434 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9435 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9437 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9438 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9439 False,
9440 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9441 &msg))
9443 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9444 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9448 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9449 IconicState. */
9450 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9452 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9454 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9455 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9458 f->async_iconified = 1;
9459 f->async_visible = 0;
9461 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9462 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9463 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9467 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9469 void
9470 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9472 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9473 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9474 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9475 Lisp_Object bar;
9476 struct scroll_bar *b;
9477 #endif
9479 BLOCK_INPUT;
9481 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9482 commands to the X server. */
9483 if (dpyinfo->display)
9485 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9486 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9487 face. */
9488 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9489 free_frame_faces (f);
9491 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9492 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9494 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9495 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9496 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9497 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9498 toolkit scroll bars. */
9499 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9501 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9502 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9504 #endif
9506 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9507 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9508 free_frame_xic (f);
9509 #endif
9511 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9512 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9514 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9515 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9517 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9518 we are using a toolkit. */
9519 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9520 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9522 free_frame_menubar (f);
9523 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9525 #ifdef USE_GTK
9526 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9527 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9529 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9530 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9531 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9533 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9534 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9535 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9536 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9537 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9538 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9540 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9541 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9542 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9543 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9544 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9545 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9546 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9547 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9548 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9549 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9550 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9551 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9552 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9553 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9554 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9556 x_free_gcs (f);
9557 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9560 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9561 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9562 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9564 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9565 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9566 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9567 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9568 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9569 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9571 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9573 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9574 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9575 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9576 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9577 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9578 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9579 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9582 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9586 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9588 static void
9589 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9591 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9593 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9594 commands to the X server. */
9595 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9596 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9598 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9602 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9604 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9605 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9606 that the window now has.
9607 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9608 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9609 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9611 #ifndef USE_GTK
9612 void
9613 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9615 XSizeHints size_hints;
9616 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9618 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9619 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9621 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9622 return;
9624 #endif
9626 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9627 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9629 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9630 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9632 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9633 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9635 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9636 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9637 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9638 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9639 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9640 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9642 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9644 int base_width, base_height;
9645 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9647 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9648 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9650 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9652 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9653 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9654 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9655 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9656 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9658 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9659 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9660 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9662 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9663 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9664 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9665 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9666 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9669 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9670 if (flags)
9672 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9673 goto no_read;
9677 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9678 long supplied_return;
9679 int value;
9681 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9682 &supplied_return);
9684 if (flags)
9685 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9686 else
9688 if (value == 0)
9689 hints.flags = 0;
9690 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9691 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9692 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9693 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9694 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9695 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9696 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9697 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9701 no_read:
9703 #ifdef PWinGravity
9704 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9705 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9707 if (user_position)
9709 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9710 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9712 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9714 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9716 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9718 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9720 static void
9721 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9723 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9724 Arg al[1];
9726 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9727 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9728 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9729 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9731 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9732 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9734 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9735 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9738 static void
9739 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9741 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9743 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9744 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9745 #endif
9747 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9749 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9750 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9751 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9752 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9754 else
9756 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9757 pixmap. */
9758 return;
9762 #ifdef USE_GTK
9764 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9765 return;
9768 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9771 Arg al[1];
9772 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9773 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9774 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9775 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9778 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9780 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9781 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9783 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9786 void
9787 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9789 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9791 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9792 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9793 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9795 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9799 /***********************************************************************
9800 Fonts
9801 ***********************************************************************/
9803 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9805 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9806 font table. */
9808 static void
9809 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9811 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9812 if (font->driver->check)
9813 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9816 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9819 /***********************************************************************
9820 Initialization
9821 ***********************************************************************/
9823 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9824 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9825 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9826 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9828 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9829 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9830 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9832 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9833 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9834 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9835 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9836 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9837 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9838 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9841 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9843 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9845 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9847 static int x_initialized;
9849 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9850 the screen number from the server number. */
9851 static int
9852 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9854 int seen_colon = 0;
9855 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9856 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9857 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9859 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9860 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9861 length_until_period++;
9863 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9864 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9865 name1 += 4;
9866 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9867 name2 += 4;
9868 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9869 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9870 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9871 name1 += system_name_length;
9872 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9873 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9874 name2 += system_name_length;
9875 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9876 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9877 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9878 name1 += length_until_period;
9879 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9880 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9881 name2 += length_until_period;
9883 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9885 if (*name1 == ':')
9886 seen_colon = 1;
9887 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9888 return 1;
9890 return (seen_colon
9891 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9892 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9895 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9896 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9897 to 5. */
9898 static void
9899 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9901 int nr = 0;
9902 int off = 0;
9904 while (!(mask & 1))
9906 off++;
9907 mask >>= 1;
9910 while (mask & 1)
9912 nr++;
9913 mask >>= 1;
9916 *offset = off;
9917 *bits = nr;
9920 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9921 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9924 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9926 int dpy_ok = 1;
9927 Display *dpy;
9929 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9930 if (dpy)
9931 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9932 else
9933 dpy_ok = 0;
9934 return dpy_ok;
9937 #ifdef USE_GTK
9938 static void
9939 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9940 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9942 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9943 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9945 #endif
9947 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9948 the structure that describes the open display.
9949 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9951 struct x_display_info *
9952 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9954 int connection;
9955 Display *dpy;
9956 struct terminal *terminal;
9957 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9958 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9959 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9960 ptrdiff_t lim;
9962 BLOCK_INPUT;
9964 if (!x_initialized)
9966 x_initialize ();
9967 ++x_initialized;
9970 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9971 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9973 #ifdef USE_GTK
9975 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9976 int argc;
9977 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9978 char **argv2 = argv;
9979 guint id;
9981 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9983 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9985 else
9987 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9988 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9990 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9991 argv[argc] = 0;
9993 argc = 0;
9994 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9996 if (! NILP (display_name))
9998 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9999 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
10002 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
10003 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10005 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10007 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
10008 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
10010 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
10011 putenv (fix_events);
10014 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
10015 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
10016 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
10017 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
10019 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
10020 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
10021 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10023 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10024 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
10026 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10027 fixup_locale ();
10028 xg_initialize ();
10030 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
10032 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
10033 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10035 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10036 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10038 s = build_string (file);
10039 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10041 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10042 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
10044 #endif
10046 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10047 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10050 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10051 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10052 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10053 errors with X11R5:
10054 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10055 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10056 So let's not use it until R6. */
10057 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10058 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10059 #endif
10062 int argc = 0;
10063 char *argv[3];
10065 argv[0] = "";
10066 argc = 1;
10067 if (xrm_option)
10069 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10070 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10072 turn_on_atimers (0);
10073 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
10074 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10075 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10076 &argc, argv);
10077 turn_on_atimers (1);
10079 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10080 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10081 fixup_locale ();
10082 #endif
10085 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10086 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10087 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10088 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10089 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10091 /* Detect failure. */
10092 if (dpy == 0)
10094 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10095 return 0;
10098 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10100 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
10101 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10103 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10106 struct x_display_info *share;
10107 Lisp_Object tail;
10109 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10110 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10111 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10112 SSDATA (display_name)))
10113 break;
10114 if (share)
10115 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10116 else
10118 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10119 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10120 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
10122 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10123 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10124 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10125 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10126 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10128 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10130 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10132 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10133 list of terminals. */
10134 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10135 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10136 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10137 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10139 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10140 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10141 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10142 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
10143 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10144 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10145 BLOCK_INPUT;
10146 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10147 terminal_list = terminal;
10148 UNGCPRO;
10151 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10152 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10153 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10154 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10155 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10157 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10160 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10161 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10162 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10164 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10165 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10166 x_display_name_list);
10167 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10169 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10171 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10172 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10173 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10174 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10176 #if 0
10177 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10178 #endif /* ! 0 */
10180 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10181 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10182 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10183 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10184 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10185 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10186 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10188 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10189 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10191 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10192 #ifdef USE_GTK
10193 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10194 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10195 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10197 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10198 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10200 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10201 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10202 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10203 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10204 #else
10205 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10206 #endif
10207 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10208 all versions. */
10209 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10211 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10212 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10213 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10214 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10215 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10216 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10217 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10218 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10219 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10220 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10221 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10222 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10223 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10224 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10225 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10226 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10227 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10228 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10229 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10230 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10231 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10232 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10233 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10234 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10235 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10236 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10237 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10238 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10240 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10241 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10242 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10244 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10246 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10247 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10248 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10249 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10250 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10251 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10254 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10255 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10257 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10259 Lisp_Object value;
10260 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10261 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10262 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10263 Qnil, Qnil);
10264 if (STRINGP (value)
10265 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10266 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10267 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10270 else
10271 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10272 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10274 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10276 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10277 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10278 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10279 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10280 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10281 for example). */
10282 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10283 double d;
10284 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10285 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10287 #endif
10289 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10291 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10292 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10293 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10294 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10295 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10296 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10297 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10298 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10299 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10303 const struct
10305 const char *name;
10306 Atom *atom;
10307 } atom_refs[] = {
10308 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10309 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10310 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10311 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10312 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10313 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10314 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10315 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10316 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10317 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10318 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10319 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10320 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10321 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10322 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10323 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10324 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10325 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10326 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10327 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10328 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10329 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10330 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10331 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10332 /* For properties of font. */
10333 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10334 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10335 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10336 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10337 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10338 /* Ghostscript support. */
10339 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10340 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10341 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10342 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10343 /* EWMH */
10344 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10345 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10346 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10347 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10348 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10349 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10350 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10351 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10352 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10353 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10354 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10355 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10356 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10357 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10358 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10359 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10360 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10361 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10362 /* Session management */
10363 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10364 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10365 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10368 int i;
10369 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10370 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10371 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10372 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10373 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10374 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10375 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10376 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10378 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10379 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10381 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10382 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10383 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10384 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10386 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10387 False, atoms_return);
10389 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10390 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10392 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10393 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10395 xfree (atom_names);
10396 xfree (atoms_return);
10399 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10400 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10401 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10402 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10404 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10405 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10406 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10408 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10409 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10412 dpyinfo->gray
10413 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10414 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10415 1, 0, 1);
10418 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10419 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10420 #endif
10422 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10424 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10425 if (connection != 0)
10426 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10428 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10429 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10430 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10432 #ifdef SIGIO
10433 if (interrupt_input)
10434 init_sigio (connection);
10435 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10437 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10439 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10440 Font font;
10442 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10443 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10444 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10445 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10446 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10447 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10448 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10449 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10450 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10451 abort ();
10452 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10453 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10454 x_uncatch_errors ();
10456 #endif
10458 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10459 for debugging X code. */
10461 Lisp_Object value;
10462 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10463 build_string ("synchronous"),
10464 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10465 Qnil, Qnil);
10466 if (STRINGP (value)
10467 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10468 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10469 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10473 Lisp_Object value;
10474 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10475 build_string ("useXIM"),
10476 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10477 Qnil, Qnil);
10478 #ifdef USE_XIM
10479 if (STRINGP (value)
10480 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10481 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10482 use_xim = 0;
10483 #else
10484 if (STRINGP (value)
10485 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10486 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10487 use_xim = 1;
10488 #endif
10491 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10492 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10493 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10494 tty. */
10495 if (terminal->id == 1)
10496 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10497 #endif
10499 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10501 return dpyinfo;
10504 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10505 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10507 static void
10508 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10510 struct terminal *t;
10512 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10513 X display. */
10514 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10515 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10517 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10518 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10519 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10520 x_session_close ();
10521 #endif
10522 delete_terminal (t);
10523 break;
10526 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10528 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10529 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10530 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10531 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10532 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10533 else
10535 Lisp_Object tail;
10537 tail = x_display_name_list;
10538 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10540 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10542 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10543 break;
10545 tail = XCDR (tail);
10549 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10550 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10552 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10553 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10554 else
10556 struct x_display_info *tail;
10558 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10559 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10560 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10563 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10564 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10565 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10566 xfree (dpyinfo);
10569 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10571 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10572 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10573 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10574 that slows us down. */
10576 static void
10577 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10579 BLOCK_INPUT;
10580 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10581 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10583 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10584 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10585 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10586 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10588 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10591 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10592 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10593 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10594 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10595 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10596 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10597 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10599 void
10600 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10602 BLOCK_INPUT;
10603 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10605 EMACS_TIME interval;
10607 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10608 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10609 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10611 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10617 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10619 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10621 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10623 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10624 x_produce_glyphs,
10625 x_write_glyphs,
10626 x_insert_glyphs,
10627 x_clear_end_of_line,
10628 x_scroll_run,
10629 x_after_update_window_line,
10630 x_update_window_begin,
10631 x_update_window_end,
10632 x_cursor_to,
10633 x_flush,
10634 #ifdef XFlush
10635 x_flush,
10636 #else
10637 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10638 #endif
10639 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10640 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10641 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10642 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10643 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10644 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10645 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10646 x_draw_glyph_string,
10647 x_define_frame_cursor,
10648 x_clear_frame_area,
10649 x_draw_window_cursor,
10650 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10651 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10655 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10656 void
10657 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10659 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10661 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10662 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10663 if (!terminal->name)
10664 return;
10666 BLOCK_INPUT;
10667 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10668 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10669 X display. */
10670 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10671 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10672 #endif
10674 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10675 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10676 if (dpyinfo->display)
10678 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10679 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10681 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10682 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10683 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10684 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10686 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10687 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10688 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10689 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10690 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10691 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10692 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10693 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10694 leaks in other situations. */
10695 #if 0
10696 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10697 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10698 #else
10699 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10700 #endif
10701 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10702 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10703 closing all the displays. */
10704 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10705 #endif
10707 #ifdef USE_GTK
10708 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10709 #else
10710 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10711 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10712 #else
10713 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10714 #endif
10715 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10718 /* Mark as dead. */
10719 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10720 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10721 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10724 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10725 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10727 static struct terminal *
10728 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10730 struct terminal *terminal;
10732 terminal = create_terminal ();
10734 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10735 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10736 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10738 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10740 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10741 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10742 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10743 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10744 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10745 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10746 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10747 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10748 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10749 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10750 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10751 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10752 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10753 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10754 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10755 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10756 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10757 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10758 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10759 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10761 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10762 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10764 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10765 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10766 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10767 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10768 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10769 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10770 off the bottom. */
10772 return terminal;
10775 void
10776 x_initialize (void)
10778 baud_rate = 19200;
10780 x_noop_count = 0;
10781 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10782 any_help_event_p = 0;
10783 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10785 #ifdef USE_GTK
10786 current_count = -1;
10787 #endif
10789 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10790 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10792 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10793 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10795 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10797 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10798 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10799 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10800 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10801 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10802 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10803 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10805 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10806 #endif
10808 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10809 #ifndef USE_GTK
10810 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10811 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10812 #endif
10813 #endif
10815 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10816 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10817 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10819 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10820 original error handler. */
10821 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10822 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10824 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10826 xgselect_initialize ();
10830 void
10831 syms_of_xterm (void)
10833 x_error_message = NULL;
10835 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10836 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10838 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10839 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10841 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10842 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10844 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10845 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10847 #ifdef USE_GTK
10848 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10849 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10851 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10852 #endif
10854 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10855 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10856 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10857 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10858 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10859 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10860 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10861 sizes. */);
10862 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10864 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10865 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10866 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10867 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10868 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10869 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10870 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10872 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10873 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10874 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10875 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10876 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10877 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10878 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10879 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10880 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10882 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10883 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10884 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10885 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10886 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10887 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10888 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10889 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10890 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10891 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10892 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10893 #elif USE_GTK
10894 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10895 #else
10896 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10897 #endif
10898 #else
10899 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10900 #endif
10902 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10903 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10905 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10906 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10907 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10908 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10909 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10910 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10911 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10912 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10913 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10915 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10916 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10917 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10918 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10919 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10920 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10922 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10923 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10924 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10925 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10926 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10927 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10929 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10930 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10931 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10932 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10933 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10934 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10936 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10937 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10938 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10939 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10940 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10941 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10943 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10944 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10945 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10946 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10947 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10948 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10951 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */